Typo in spelling Makefile.in...
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c
SS
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright 1988-1999
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c
5@c %**start of header
6@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8@setfilename gdb.info
9@c
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c
c906108c 12@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
13@setchapternewpage odd
14@c %**end of header
15
16@iftex
17@c @smallbook
18@c @cropmarks
19@end iftex
20
21@finalout
22@syncodeindex ky cp
23
24@c readline appendices use @vindex
25@syncodeindex vr cp
26
27@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
28@set EDITION Seventh
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
31@set DATE February 1999
32
33@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO-2 macros and info-makers to format properly.
34
35@ifinfo
36@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
37@c manuals to an info tree. zoo@cygnus.com is developing this facility.
38@format
39START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
40* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
41END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
42@end format
43@end ifinfo
44@c
45@c
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
51of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
52for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
57this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
58are preserved on all copies.
59
60@ignore
61Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
62results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
63notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
64(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
65
66@end ignore
67Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
68manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
69entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
70permission notice identical to this one.
71
72Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
73into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
74@end ifinfo
75
76@titlepage
77@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 79@sp 1
c906108c
SS
80@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81@subtitle @value{DATE}
82@author Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch
c906108c 83@page
c906108c
SS
84@tex
85{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 86\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
87\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89}
90@end tex
53a5351d
JM
91
92@c ISBN seems to be wrong...
c906108c
SS
93
94@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
95Copyright @copyright{} 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96@sp 2
c906108c
SS
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9859 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
99Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
100Printed copies are available for $20 each. @*
101ISBN 1-882114-11-6 @*
c906108c
SS
102
103Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
104this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
105are preserved on all copies.
106
107Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
108manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
109entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
110permission notice identical to this one.
111
112Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
113into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
114@end titlepage
115@page
116
117@ifinfo
53a5351d 118@node Top
c906108c
SS
119@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
120
121This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
122
123This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
124@value{GDBVN}.
125
126Copyright (C) 1988-1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
127@menu
128* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 129* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
130
131* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
132* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
133* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
134* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
135* Stack:: Examining the stack
136* Source:: Examining source files
137* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 138
7a292a7a 139* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
140
141* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
142* Altering:: Altering execution
143* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
144* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 148* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c906108c
SS
149
150* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 151* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
152
153* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
154* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
155* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
156* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
157@end menu
158
159@end ifinfo
160
53a5351d 161@node Summary
c906108c
SS
162@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
163
164The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
165going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
166program was doing at the moment it crashed.
167
168@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
169these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
170
171@itemize @bullet
172@item
173Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
174
175@item
176Make your program stop on specified conditions.
177
178@item
179Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
180
181@item
182Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
183effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
184@end itemize
185
cce74817 186You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 187For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
188For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
189
cce74817
JM
190@cindex Chill
191@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 192Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 193see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 194
cce74817
JM
195@cindex Pascal
196Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
197nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
198entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
199syntax.
c906108c 200
c906108c
SS
201@cindex Fortran
202@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 203it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 204underscore.
c906108c 205
c906108c
SS
206@menu
207* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
208* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
209@end menu
210
53a5351d 211@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
212@unnumberedsec Free software
213
214@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
215General Public License
216(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
217program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
218freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
219the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
220Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
221Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
222
223Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
224you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
225from anyone else.
226
53a5351d 227@node Contributors
c906108c
SS
228@unnumberedsec Contributors to GDB
229
230Richard Stallman was the original author of GDB, and of many other
231@sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its development.
232This section attempts to credit major contributors. One of the virtues
233of free software is that everyone is free to contribute to it; with
234regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The file
235@file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
236blow-by-blow account.
237
238Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
239
240@quotation
241@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
242or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
243omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
244@end quotation
245
246So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
247particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
248releases:
249Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
250Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
251Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
252Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
253Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
254John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
255Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
256and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
257
258Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
259Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
260
c906108c
SS
261Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in GDB,
262with significant additional contributions from Per Bothner. James
263Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on C++ was by Peter
264TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c
SS
265
266@value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
267object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
268Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
269
270David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
271the original support for encapsulated COFF.
272
273Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
274
275Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
276Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
277support.
278Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
279Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
280Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
281David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
282Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
283Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
284Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
285Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
286Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
287Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
288Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
289Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
290Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
291Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
292Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
293
294Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
295
296Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
297libraries.
298
299Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
300about several machine instruction sets.
301
302Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
303remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
304contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
305and RDI targets, respectively.
306
307Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
308command-line editing and command history.
309
7a292a7a
SS
310Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
311Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c
SS
312
313Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
c906108c
SS
314He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
315symbols.
c906108c
SS
316
317Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
318Super-H processors.
319
320NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
321
322Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
323
324Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
325
326Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
327
328Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors
329
330Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
331watchpoints.
332
333Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
334
335Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
336
337Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
338nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout GDB.
339
340The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
341support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
342(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
343compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
344John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
345Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
346information in this manual.
347
348Cygnus Solutions has sponsored GDB maintenance and much of its
349development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on GDB
2df3850c
JM
350fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
351Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
352Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
353Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
354Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
355addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
356JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
357Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
358Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
359Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
360Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
361Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
362Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
363
364
53a5351d 365@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
366@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
367
368You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
369However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
370debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
371
372@iftex
373In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
374to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
375@end iftex
376
377@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
378@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
379
380One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
381processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
382quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
383definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
384session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
385then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
386same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
387@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
388procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
389
390@smallexample
391$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
392$ @b{./m4}
393@b{define(foo,0000)}
394
395@b{foo}
3960000
397@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
398
399@b{bar}
4000000
401@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
402
403@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
404@b{baz}
405@b{C-d}
406m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
407@end smallexample
408
409@noindent
410Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
411
c906108c
SS
412@smallexample
413$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
414@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
415@c FIXME... format to come out better.
416@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
417 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
418 the conditions.
419There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
420 for details.
421
422@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
423(@value{GDBP})
424@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
425
426@noindent
427@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
428rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
429We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
430that examples fit in this manual.
431
432@smallexample
433(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
434@end smallexample
435
436@noindent
437We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
438Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
439@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
440@code{break} command.
441
442@smallexample
443(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
444Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
445@end smallexample
446
447@noindent
448Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
449control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
450subroutine, the program runs as usual:
451
452@smallexample
453(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
454Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
455@b{define(foo,0000)}
456
457@b{foo}
4580000
459@end smallexample
460
461@noindent
462To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
463suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
464context where it stops.
465
466@smallexample
467@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
468
469Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
470 at builtin.c:879
471879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
472@end smallexample
473
474@noindent
475Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
476the next line of the current function.
477
478@smallexample
479(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
480882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
481 : nil,
482@end smallexample
483
484@noindent
485@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
486by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
487@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
488subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
489
490@smallexample
491(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
492set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
493 at input.c:530
494530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
495@end smallexample
496
497@noindent
498The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
499suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
500shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
501command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
502in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
503stack frame for each active subroutine.
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
507#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
508 at input.c:530
509#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
510 at builtin.c:882
511#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
512#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
513 at macro.c:71
514#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
515#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
516@end smallexample
517
518@noindent
519We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
520times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
521falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
522
523@smallexample
524(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5250x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
526(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5270x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
528def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
529(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
530536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
531 : xstrdup(rq);
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
534@end smallexample
535
536@noindent
537The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
538@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
539and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
540(@code{print}) to see their values.
541
542@smallexample
543(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
544$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
545(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
546$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
547@end smallexample
548
549@noindent
550@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
551To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
552surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
553
554@smallexample
555(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
556533 xfree(rquote);
557534
558535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
559 : xstrdup (lq);
560536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
561 : xstrdup (rq);
562537
563538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
564539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
565540 @}
566541
567542 void
568@end smallexample
569
570@noindent
571Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
572@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
573
574@smallexample
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
576539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
578540 @}
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
580$3 = 9
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
582$4 = 7
583@end smallexample
584
585@noindent
586That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
587@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
588@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
589the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
590any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
591assignments.
592
593@smallexample
594(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
595$5 = 7
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
597$6 = 9
598@end smallexample
599
600@noindent
601Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
602@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
603executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
604example that caused trouble initially:
605
606@smallexample
607(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
608Continuing.
609
610@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
611
612baz
6130000
614@end smallexample
615
616@noindent
617Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
618problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
619lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
620
621@smallexample
622@b{C-d}
623Program exited normally.
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
628indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
629session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
633@end smallexample
c906108c 634
53a5351d 635@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
636@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
637
638This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
639The essentials are:
640@itemize @bullet
641@item
53a5351d 642type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
643@item
644type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
645@end itemize
646
647@menu
648* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
649* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
650* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
651@end menu
652
53a5351d 653@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
654@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
655
c906108c
SS
656Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
657@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
658
659You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
660to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
661
c906108c
SS
662The command-line options described here are designed
663to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
664options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
665
666The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
667specifying an executable program:
668
669@example
670@value{GDBP} @var{program}
671@end example
672
c906108c
SS
673@noindent
674You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
675specified:
676
677@example
678@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
679@end example
680
681You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
682to debug a running process:
683
684@example
685@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
686@end example
687
688@noindent
689would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
690named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
691
c906108c 692Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
693complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
694debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
695``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
696will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c
SS
697
698You can run @code{gdb} without printing the front material, which describes
699@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
700
701@smallexample
702@value{GDBP} -silent
703@end smallexample
704
705@noindent
706You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
707options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
708
709@noindent
710Type
711
712@example
713@value{GDBP} -help
714@end example
715
716@noindent
717to display all available options and briefly describe their use
718(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
719
720All options and command line arguments you give are processed
721in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
722@samp{-x} option is used.
723
724
725@menu
c906108c
SS
726* File Options:: Choosing files
727* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
728@end menu
729
c906108c
SS
730@node File Options
731@subsection Choosing files
732
2df3850c 733When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
734specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
735the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
736@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
737that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
738@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
739that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
740the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
741
742If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
743such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
744argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
745
746Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
747following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
748them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
749(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
750than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
751
752@table @code
753@item -symbols @var{file}
754@itemx -s @var{file}
755Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
756
757@item -exec @var{file}
758@itemx -e @var{file}
7a292a7a
SS
759Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
760and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
761
762@item -se @var{file}
763Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
764file.
765
c906108c
SS
766@item -core @var{file}
767@itemx -c @var{file}
768Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
769
770@item -c @var{number}
771Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
772(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
773case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
774
775@item -command @var{file}
776@itemx -x @var{file}
777Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
778Files,, Command files}.
779
780@item -directory @var{directory}
781@itemx -d @var{directory}
782Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
783
c906108c
SS
784@item -m
785@itemx -mapped
786@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
787supported on all systems.}@*
788If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
789system call, you can use this option
790to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
791program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
792called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{./fred.syms}.
793Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
794and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
795the symbol table from the executable program.
796
797The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
798is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
799table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 800
c906108c
SS
801@item -r
802@itemx -readnow
803Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
804the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
805This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 806
c906108c
SS
807@end table
808
2df3850c 809You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 810order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
811information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
812on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
813but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
814
815@example
2df3850c 816gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 817@end example
c906108c 818
53a5351d 819@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
820@subsection Choosing modes
821
822You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
823batch mode or quiet mode.
824
825@table @code
826@item -nx
827@itemx -n
2df3850c
JM
828Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
829called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
830@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
831options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
832files}.
c906108c
SS
833
834@item -quiet
835@itemx -q
836``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
837messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
838
839@item -batch
840Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
841command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
842initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
843nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
844in the command files.
845
2df3850c
JM
846Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
847example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
848make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
849
850@example
851Program exited normally.
852@end example
853
854@noindent
2df3850c
JM
855(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
856@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
857mode.
858
859@item -nowindows
860@itemx -nw
861``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
862(GUI) built in, then this option tells GDB to only use the command-line
863interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
864
865@item -windows
866@itemx -w
867If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
868used if possible.
c906108c
SS
869
870@item -cd @var{directory}
871Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
872instead of the current directory.
873
c906108c
SS
874@item -fullname
875@itemx -f
7a292a7a
SS
876@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
877subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
878number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
879displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
880recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
881the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
882and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
883@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
884frame.
c906108c 885
2df3850c
JM
886@item -baud @var{bps}
887@itemx -b @var{bps}
c906108c
SS
888Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
889interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -tty @var{device}
892Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
893@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 894
53a5351d
JM
895@c resolve the situation of these eventually
896@c @item -tui
897@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
898@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
899@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
900@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
901@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
902
903@c @item -xdb
904@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
905@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
906@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
907@c systems.
908
c906108c
SS
909@end table
910
53a5351d 911@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
912@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
913@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
914@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
915
916@table @code
917@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
918@kindex q
919@item quit
920To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated @code{q}), or
921type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you do not supply
922@var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; otherwise it will
923terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the error code.
924@end table
925
926@cindex interrupt
927An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
928terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
929returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
930character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
931until a time when it is safe.
932
c906108c
SS
933If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
934device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
935(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 936
53a5351d 937@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
938@section Shell commands
939
940If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
941debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
942just use the @code{shell} command.
943
944@table @code
945@kindex shell
946@cindex shell escape
947@item shell @var{command string}
948Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 949If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
950shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
951(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
952@end table
953
954The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
955You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
956@value{GDBN}:
957
958@table @code
959@kindex make
960@cindex calling make
961@item make @var{make-args}
962Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
963arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
964@end table
965
53a5351d 966@node Commands
c906108c
SS
967@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
968
969You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
970name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
971@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
972key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
973show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
974
975@menu
976* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
977* Completion:: Command completion
978* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
979@end menu
980
53a5351d 981@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
982@section Command syntax
983
984A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
985how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
986arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
987command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
988step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
989with no arguments. Some command names do not allow any arguments.
990
991@cindex abbreviation
992@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
993unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
994documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
995abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
996equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
997names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
998arguments to the @code{help} command.
999
1000@cindex repeating commands
1001@kindex RET
1002A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1003repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1004will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1005repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1006repeat.
1007
1008The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1009@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1010exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1011
1012@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1013output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1014(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1015@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1016repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1017
1018@kindex #
1019@cindex comment
1020Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1021nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1022Files,,Command files}).
1023
53a5351d 1024@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1025@section Command completion
1026
1027@cindex completion
1028@cindex word completion
1029@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1030only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1031are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1032commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1033
1034Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1035of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1036word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1037enter it). For example, if you type
1038
1039@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1040@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1041@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1042@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1043@example
1044(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1045@end example
1046
1047@noindent
1048@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1049the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1050
1051@example
1052(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1053@end example
1054
1055@noindent
1056You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1057breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1058@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1059were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1060might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1061to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1062
1063If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1064@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1065characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1066@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1067example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1068begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1069just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1070function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1071example:
1072
1073@example
1074(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1075@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1076make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1077make_abs_section make_function_type
1078make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1079make_cleanup make_reference_type
1080make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1081(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1082@end example
1083
1084@noindent
1085After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1086partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1087command.
1088
1089If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1090can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1091means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1092key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1093one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1094
1095@cindex quotes in commands
1096@cindex completion of quoted strings
1097Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1098parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1099its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1100situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1101@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1102
c906108c
SS
1103The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1104name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1105(multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1106type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1107distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1108@code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1109@code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1110facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1111beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1112consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1113@kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1114
1115@example
1116(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @key{M-?}
1117bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1118(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1119@end example
1120
1121In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1122quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1123completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1124place:
1125
1126@example
1127(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1128@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1129(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1130@end example
1131
1132@noindent
1133In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1134you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1135completion on an overloaded symbol.
1136
d4f3574e 1137For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
c906108c
SS
1138expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1139overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
d4f3574e 1140see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
c906108c
SS
1141
1142
53a5351d 1143@node Help
c906108c
SS
1144@section Getting help
1145@cindex online documentation
1146@kindex help
1147
1148You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1149using the command @code{help}.
1150
1151@table @code
1152@kindex h
1153@item help
1154@itemx h
1155You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1156display a short list of named classes of commands:
1157
1158@smallexample
1159(@value{GDBP}) help
1160List of classes of commands:
1161
2df3850c 1162aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1163breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1164data -- Examining data
c906108c 1165files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1166internals -- Maintenance commands
1167obscure -- Obscure features
1168running -- Running the program
1169stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1170status -- Status inquiries
1171support -- Support facilities
2df3850c 1172tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without stopping the program
c906108c 1173user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c
SS
1174
1175Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1176commands in that class.
1177Type "help" followed by command name for full
1178documentation.
1179Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1180(@value{GDBP})
1181@end smallexample
1182
1183@item help @var{class}
1184Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1185list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1186help display for the class @code{status}:
1187
1188@smallexample
1189(@value{GDBP}) help status
1190Status inquiries.
1191
1192List of commands:
1193
1194@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1195@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1196info -- Generic command for showing things
1197 about the program being debugged
1198show -- Generic command for showing things
1199 about the debugger
c906108c
SS
1200
1201Type "help" followed by command name for full
1202documentation.
1203Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1204(@value{GDBP})
1205@end smallexample
1206
1207@item help @var{command}
1208With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1209short paragraph on how to use that command.
1210
1211@kindex complete
1212@item complete @var{args}
1213The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1214for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1215command you want completed. For example:
1216
1217@smallexample
1218complete i
1219@end smallexample
1220
1221@noindent results in:
1222
1223@smallexample
1224@group
2df3850c
JM
1225if
1226ignore
c906108c
SS
1227info
1228inspect
c906108c
SS
1229@end group
1230@end smallexample
1231
1232@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1233@end table
1234
1235In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1236and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1237of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1238manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1239under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1240all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1241
1242@c @group
1243@table @code
1244@kindex info
1245@kindex i
1246@item info
1247This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1248program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1249with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1250registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1251You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1252@w{@code{help info}}.
1253
1254@kindex set
1255@item set
1256You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1257@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1258@code{set prompt $}.
1259
1260@kindex show
1261@item show
1262In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1263@value{GDBN} itself.
1264You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1265related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1266system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1267which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1268
1269@kindex info set
1270To display all the settable parameters and their current
1271values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1272@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1273@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1274@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1275@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1276@end table
1277@c @end group
1278
1279Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1280exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1281
1282@table @code
1283@kindex show version
1284@cindex version number
1285@item show version
1286Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1287information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1288@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1289version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1290commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1291system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1292variant versions of @value{GDBN} in GNU/Linux distributions as well.
1293The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1294@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1295
1296@kindex show copying
1297@item show copying
1298Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1299
1300@kindex show warranty
1301@item show warranty
2df3850c
JM
1302Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1303if your version of @value{GDB} comes with one.
1304
c906108c
SS
1305@end table
1306
53a5351d 1307@node Running
c906108c
SS
1308@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1309
1310When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1311debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1312
1313You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1314of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1315your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1316kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1317
1318@menu
1319* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1320* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1321* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1322* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1323
1324* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1325* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1326* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1327* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1328
1329* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1330* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1331@end menu
1332
53a5351d 1333@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1334@section Compiling for debugging
1335
1336In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1337debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1338is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1339variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1340and addresses in the executable code.
1341
1342To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1343the compiler.
1344
1345Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1346options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1347executables containing debugging information.
1348
53a5351d
JM
1349@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1350without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1351recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1352program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1353in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1354
1355@cindex optimized code, debugging
1356@cindex debugging optimized code
1357When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1358optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1359really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1360exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1361variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1362variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1363
1364Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1365@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1366doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1367please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1368
1369Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1370@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1371format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1372
1373@need 2000
53a5351d 1374@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1375@section Starting your program
1376@cindex starting
1377@cindex running
1378
1379@table @code
1380@kindex run
1381@item run
1382@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1383Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1384You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1385argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1386@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1387(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1388
1389@end table
1390
c906108c
SS
1391If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1392supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1393that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1394@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1395
1396The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1397receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1398information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1399can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1400your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1401divided into four categories:
1402
1403@table @asis
1404@item The @emph{arguments.}
1405Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1406@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1407is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1408(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1409the arguments.
1410In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1411@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1412@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1413
1414@item The @emph{environment.}
1415Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1416use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1417environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1418your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1419
1420@item The @emph{working directory.}
1421Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1422the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1423@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1424
1425@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1426Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1427standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1428in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1429set a different device for your program.
1430@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1431
1432@cindex pipes
1433@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1434pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1435program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1436wrong program.
1437@end table
c906108c
SS
1438
1439When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1440immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1441of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1442stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1443or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1444
1445If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1446time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1447table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1448your current breakpoints.
1449
53a5351d 1450@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1451@section Your program's arguments
1452
1453@cindex arguments (to your program)
1454The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1455@code{run} command.
1456They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1457performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1458@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1459@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1460the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1461
1462On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1463@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1464calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1465the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1466
1467@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1468@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1469
1470@kindex set args
1471@table @code
1472@item set args
1473Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1474@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1475with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1476using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1477it again without arguments.
1478
1479@kindex show args
1480@item show args
1481Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1482@end table
1483
53a5351d 1484@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1485@section Your program's environment
1486
1487@cindex environment (of your program)
1488The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1489their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1490your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1491path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1492the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1493debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1494environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1495
1496@table @code
1497@kindex path
1498@item path @var{directory}
1499Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1500(the search path for executables), for both @value{GDBN} and your program.
d4f3574e
SS
1501You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1502system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1503MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1504is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1505
1506You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1507working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1508use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1509@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1510@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1511@var{directory} to the search path.
1512@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1513@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1514
1515@kindex show paths
1516@item show paths
1517Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1518environment variable).
1519
1520@kindex show environment
1521@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1522Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1523your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1524print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1525your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1526
1527@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1528@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1529Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1530changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1531be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1532any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1533parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1534null value.
1535@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1536@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1537
1538For example, this command:
1539
1540@example
1541set env USER = foo
1542@end example
1543
1544@noindent
d4f3574e 1545tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1546@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1547are not actually required.)
1548
1549@kindex unset environment
1550@item unset environment @var{varname}
1551Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1552program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1553@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1554rather than assigning it an empty value.
1555@end table
1556
d4f3574e
SS
1557@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1558the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1559by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1560@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1561that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1562@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1563your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1564files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1565@file{.profile}.
1566
53a5351d 1567@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1568@section Your program's working directory
1569
1570@cindex working directory (of your program)
1571Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1572working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1573The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1574from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1575working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1576
1577The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1578that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1579specify files}.
1580
1581@table @code
1582@kindex cd
1583@item cd @var{directory}
1584Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1585
1586@kindex pwd
1587@item pwd
1588Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1589@end table
1590
53a5351d 1591@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1592@section Your program's input and output
1593
1594@cindex redirection
1595@cindex i/o
1596@cindex terminal
1597By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1598the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1599to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1600modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1601running your program.
1602
1603@table @code
1604@kindex info terminal
1605@item info terminal
1606Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1607program is using.
1608@end table
1609
1610You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1611redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1612
1613@example
1614run > outfile
1615@end example
1616
1617@noindent
1618starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1619
1620@kindex tty
1621@cindex controlling terminal
1622Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1623with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1624argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1625commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1626process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1627
1628@example
1629tty /dev/ttyb
1630@end example
1631
1632@noindent
1633directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1634default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1635that as their controlling terminal.
1636
1637An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1638effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1639terminal.
1640
1641When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1642command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1643for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1644
53a5351d 1645@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1646@section Debugging an already-running process
1647@kindex attach
1648@cindex attach
1649
1650@table @code
1651@item attach @var{process-id}
1652This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1653outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1654targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1655find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1656or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1657
1658@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1659executing the command.
1660@end table
1661
1662To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1663which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1664programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1665also have permission to send the process a signal.
1666
1667When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1668the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1669the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1670(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1671the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1672Specify Files}.
1673
1674The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1675process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1676with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1677you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1678can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1679process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1680attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex detach
1684@item detach
1685When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1686@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1687the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1688that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1689are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1690@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1691executing the command.
1692@end table
1693
1694If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1695attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1696for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1697control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1698confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1699messages}).
1700
53a5351d 1701@node Kill Process
c906108c 1702@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1703
1704@table @code
1705@kindex kill
1706@item kill
1707Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1708@end table
1709
1710This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1711running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1712is running.
1713
1714On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1715while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1716@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1717outside the debugger.
1718
1719The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1720relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1721executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1722next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1723reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1724breakpoint settings).
1725
53a5351d 1726@node Threads
c906108c 1727@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1728
1729@cindex threads of execution
1730@cindex multiple threads
1731@cindex switching threads
1732In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1733may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1734of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1735the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1736that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1737modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1738registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1739
1740@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1741programs:
1742
1743@itemize @bullet
1744@item automatic notification of new threads
1745@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1746@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1747@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1748a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1749@item thread-specific breakpoints
1750@end itemize
1751
c906108c
SS
1752@quotation
1753@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1754@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1755If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1756effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1757from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1758like this:
1759
1760@smallexample
1761(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1762(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1763Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1764see the IDs of currently known threads.
1765@end smallexample
1766@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1767@c doesn't support threads"?
1768@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1769
1770@cindex focus of debugging
1771@cindex current thread
1772The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1773threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1774control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1775This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1776program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1777
c906108c
SS
1778@kindex New @var{systag}
1779@cindex thread identifier (system)
1780@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1781@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1782@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1783Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1784the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1785form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1786whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1787LynxOS, you might see
1788
1789@example
1790[New process 35 thread 27]
1791@end example
1792
1793@noindent
1794when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1795the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1796further qualifier.
1797
1798@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1799@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1800@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1801@c program?
1802@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1803@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1804@c threads ab initio?
1805
1806@cindex thread number
1807@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1808For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1809number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1810
1811@table @code
1812@kindex info threads
1813@item info threads
1814Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1815program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1816
1817@enumerate
1818@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1819
1820@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1821
1822@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1823@end enumerate
1824
1825@noindent
1826An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1827indicates the current thread.
1828
1829For example,
1830@end table
1831@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1832
1833@smallexample
1834(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1835 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1836 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
1837* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
1838 at threadtest.c:68
1839@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
1840
1841On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
1842
1843@cindex thread number
1844@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1845For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1846number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
1847thread in your program.
1848
1849@kindex New @var{systag}
1850@cindex thread identifier (system)
1851@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1852@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1853@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1854Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1855both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1856form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1857whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1858HP-UX, you see
1859
1860@example
1861[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
1862@end example
1863
1864@noindent
1865when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
1866
1867@table @code
1868@kindex info threads
1869@item info threads
1870Display a summary of all threads currently in your
1871program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
1872
1873@enumerate
1874@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
1875
1876@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
1877
1878@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
1879@end enumerate
1880
1881@noindent
1882An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
1883indicates the current thread.
1884
1885For example,
1886@end table
1887@c end table here to get a little more width for example
1888
1889@example
1890(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1891 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") at quicksort.c:137
1892 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1893 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () from /usr/lib/libc.2
1894@end example
c906108c
SS
1895
1896@table @code
1897@kindex thread @var{threadno}
1898@item thread @var{threadno}
1899Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
1900argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
1901shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
1902@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
1903you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
1904
1905@smallexample
1906@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
1907(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 1908[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
19090x34e5 in sigpause ()
1910@end smallexample
1911
1912@noindent
1913As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
1914@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
1915threads.
1916
1917@kindex thread apply
1918@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
1919The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
1920more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
1921with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
1922@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
1923threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
1924@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
1925@end table
1926
1927@cindex automatic thread selection
1928@cindex switching threads automatically
1929@cindex threads, automatic switching
1930Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
1931signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
1932signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
1933message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
1934thread.
1935
1936@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
1937more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
1938programs with multiple threads.
1939
1940@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
1941watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 1942
53a5351d 1943@node Processes
c906108c
SS
1944@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
1945
1946@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
1947@cindex multiple processes
1948@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
1949On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
1950programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
1951function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
1952parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
1953set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
1954will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
1955will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
1956
1957However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
1958which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
1959the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
1960only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
1961so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
1962on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
1963get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
1964@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 1965the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 1966the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 1967
53a5351d
JM
1968On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
1969debugging programs that create additional processes using the
1970@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
1971
1972By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
1973the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
1974
1975If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
1976use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
1977
1978@table @code
1979@kindex set follow-fork-mode
1980@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
1981Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
1982@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
1983process. The @var{mode} can be:
1984
1985@table @code
1986@item parent
1987The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 1988unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
1989
1990@item child
1991The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
1992unimpeded.
1993
1994@item ask
1995The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
1996@end table
1997
1998@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 1999Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2000@end table
2001
2002If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2003@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2004breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2005@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2006the child process's @code{main}.
2007
2008When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2009child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2010
2011If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2012call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2013use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2014argument.
2015
2016You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2017a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2018Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2019
53a5351d 2020@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2021@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2022
2023The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2024program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2025trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2026
7a292a7a
SS
2027Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2028such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2029@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2030change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2031continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2032ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2033explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2034
2035@table @code
2036@kindex info program
2037@item info program
2038Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2039running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2040@end table
2041
2042@menu
2043* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2044* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2045* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2046* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2047@end menu
2048
53a5351d 2049@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2050@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2051
2052@cindex breakpoints
2053A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2054the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2055control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2056breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2057Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2058should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2059program.
2060
2061In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2062breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2063a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2064is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2065not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2066arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2067
2068@cindex watchpoints
2069@cindex memory tracing
2070@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2071@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2072A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2073when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2074command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2075watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2076any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2077and watchpoints using the same commands.
2078
2079You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2080whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2081Automatic display}.
2082
2083@cindex catchpoints
2084@cindex breakpoint on events
2085A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2086when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2087exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2088different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2089catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2090other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2091@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex breakpoint numbers
2094@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2095@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2096catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2097starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2098features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2099breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2100@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2101enable it again.
2102
c5394b80
JM
2103@cindex breakpoint ranges
2104@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2105Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2106operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2107@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2108hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2109all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2110
c906108c
SS
2111@menu
2112* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2113* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2114* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2115* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2116* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2117* Conditions:: Break conditions
2118* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2119* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2120* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2121@end menu
2122
53a5351d 2123@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2124@subsection Setting breakpoints
2125
2126@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2127@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2128@c
2129@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2130
2131@kindex break
2132@kindex b
2133@kindex $bpnum
2134@cindex latest breakpoint
2135Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2136@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2137number of the breakpoints you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2138Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2139convenience variables.
2140
2141You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2142
2143@table @code
2144@item break @var{function}
2145Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c
SS
2146When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2147C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2148@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2149
2150@item break +@var{offset}
2151@itemx break -@var{offset}
2152Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2153at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2154(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2155
2156@item break @var{linenum}
2157Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2158The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2159The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2160code on that line.
2161
2162@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2163Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2164
2165@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2166Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2167@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2168superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2169functions.
2170
2171@item break *@var{address}
2172Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2173breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2174information or source files.
2175
2176@item break
2177When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2178the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2179(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2180innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2181returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2182@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2183that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2184@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2185the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2186inside loops.
2187
2188@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2189least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2190would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2191breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2192existed when your program stopped.
2193
2194@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2195Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2196@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2197value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2198@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2199above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2200,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2201
2202@kindex tbreak
2203@item tbreak @var{args}
2204Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2205same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2206way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2207program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2208
c906108c
SS
2209@kindex hbreak
2210@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2211Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2212@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2213breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2214have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2215debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2216changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2217provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2218will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2219address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2220breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2221example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2222@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2223or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2224(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2225
2226@kindex thbreak
2227@item thbreak @var{args}
2228Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2229are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2230the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2231the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2232first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2233command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2234may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2235See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2236
2237@kindex rbreak
2238@cindex regular expression
2239@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2240Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2241@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2242matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2243breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2244the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2245them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2246
2247The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2248like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2249shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2250an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2251@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2252match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2253
c906108c
SS
2254When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2255breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2256classes.
c906108c
SS
2257
2258@kindex info breakpoints
2259@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2260@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2261@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2262@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2263Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2264not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2265
2266@table @emph
2267@item Breakpoint Numbers
2268@item Type
2269Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2270@item Disposition
2271Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2272@item Enabled or Disabled
2273Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2274that are not enabled.
2275@item Address
2df3850c 2276Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2277@item What
2278Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2279line number.
2280@end table
2281
2282@noindent
2283If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2284the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2285are listed after that.
2286
2287@noindent
2288@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2289number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2290convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2291the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2292listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2293
2294@noindent
2295@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2296has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2297@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2298hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2299was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2300will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2301@end table
2302
2303@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2304your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2305the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2306(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2307
2308@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2309@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2310@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2311purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2312These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2313@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2314
2315You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2316@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2317
2318@table @code
2319@kindex maint info breakpoints
2320@item maint info breakpoints
2321Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2322breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2323internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2324breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2325is shown:
2326
2327@table @code
2328@item breakpoint
2329Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2330
2331@item watchpoint
2332Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2333
2334@item longjmp
2335Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2336@code{longjmp} calls.
2337
2338@item longjmp resume
2339Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2340
2341@item until
2342Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2343
2344@item finish
2345Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2346
c906108c
SS
2347@item shlib events
2348Shared library events.
53a5351d 2349
c906108c 2350@end table
53a5351d 2351
c906108c
SS
2352@end table
2353
2354
53a5351d 2355@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2356@subsection Setting watchpoints
2357
2358@cindex setting watchpoints
2359@cindex software watchpoints
2360@cindex hardware watchpoints
2361You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2362expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2363this may happen.
2364
2365Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2366hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2367program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2368times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2369catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2370culprit.)
2371
d4f3574e 2372On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2373@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2374hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2375program.
2376
2377@table @code
2378@kindex watch
2379@item watch @var{expr}
2380Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2381is written into by the program and its value changes.
2382
2383@kindex rwatch
2384@item rwatch @var{expr}
2385Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2386
2387@kindex awatch
2388@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2389Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2390by the program.
c906108c
SS
2391
2392@kindex info watchpoints
2393@item info watchpoints
2394This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2395it is the same as @code{info break}.
2396@end table
2397
2398@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2399watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2400value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2401cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2402executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2403statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2404
2405When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2406
2407@example
2408Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2409@end example
2410
2411@noindent
2412if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2413
7be570e7
JM
2414Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2415hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2416value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2417every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2418that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2419hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2420will print a message like this:
2421
2422@smallexample
2423Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2424@end smallexample
2425
2426Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2427data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2428watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2429can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2430cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2431double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2432wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2433into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2434
2435If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2436to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2437Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2438time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2439able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2440warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2441
2442@smallexample
2443Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2444@end smallexample
2445
2446@noindent
2447If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2448
2449The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2450or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2451data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2452hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2453both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2454watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2455@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2456watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2457@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2458Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2459
2460If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2461any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2462kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2463
7be570e7
JM
2464@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2465(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2466they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2467which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2468being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2469and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2470rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2471way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2472@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2473
c906108c
SS
2474@quotation
2475@cindex watchpoints and threads
2476@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2477@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2478usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2479can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2480you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2481thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2482can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2483@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2484the expression.
53a5351d 2485
d4f3574e 2486@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2487@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2488have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2489watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2490single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2491change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2492confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2493software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2494when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2495watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2496@end quotation
c906108c 2497
53a5351d 2498@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2499@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2500@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2501@cindex exception handlers
2502@cindex event handling
2503
2504You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2505kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2506shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex catch
2510@item catch @var{event}
2511Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2512@table @code
2513@item throw
2514@kindex catch throw
2515The throwing of a C++ exception.
2516
2517@item catch
2518@kindex catch catch
2519The catching of a C++ exception.
2520
2521@item exec
2522@kindex catch exec
2523A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2524
2525@item fork
2526@kindex catch fork
2527A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2528
2529@item vfork
2530@kindex catch vfork
2531A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2532
2533@item load
2534@itemx load @var{libname}
2535@kindex catch load
2536The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2537@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2538
2539@item unload
2540@itemx unload @var{libname}
2541@kindex catch unload
2542The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2543of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2544@end table
2545
2546@item tcatch @var{event}
2547Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2548automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2549
2550@end table
2551
2552Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2553
2554There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2555(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2556
2557@itemize @bullet
2558@item
2559If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2560control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2561raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2562returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2563simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2564that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2565you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2566disabled within interactive calls.
2567
2568@item
2569You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2570
2571@item
2572You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2573@end itemize
2574
2575@cindex raise exceptions
2576Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2577if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2578stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2579can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2580breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2581out where the exception was raised.
2582
2583To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2584knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2585raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2586which has the following ANSI C interface:
2587
2588@example
2589 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2590 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2591 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2592@end example
2593
2594@noindent
2595To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2596unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2597(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2598
2599With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2600that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2601a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2602breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2603raised.
2604
2605
53a5351d 2606@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2607@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2608
2609@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2610@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2611It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2612catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2613to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2614breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2615
2616With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2617where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2618delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2619their breakpoint numbers.
2620
2621It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2622automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2623when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2624
2625@table @code
2626@kindex clear
2627@item clear
2628Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2629selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2630the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2631breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2632
2633@item clear @var{function}
2634@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2635Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2636
2637@item clear @var{linenum}
2638@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2639Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2640
2641@cindex delete breakpoints
2642@kindex delete
2643@kindex d
c5394b80
JM
2644@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2645Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2646ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2647breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2648confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2649@end table
2650
53a5351d 2651@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2652@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2653
2654@kindex disable breakpoints
2655@kindex enable breakpoints
2656Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2657prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2658it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2659that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2660
2661You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2662the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2663or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2664@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2665catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2666
2667A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2668states of enablement:
2669
2670@itemize @bullet
2671@item
2672Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2673with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2674@item
2675Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2676@item
2677Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2678disabled.
c906108c
SS
2679@item
2680Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2681immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2682set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2683@end itemize
2684
2685You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2686watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2687
2688@table @code
2689@kindex disable breakpoints
2690@kindex disable
2691@kindex dis
c5394b80 2692@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2693Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2694listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2695options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2696case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2697@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2698
2699@kindex enable breakpoints
2700@kindex enable
c5394b80 2701@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2702Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2703become effective once again in stopping your program.
2704
c5394b80 2705@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2706Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2707of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2708
c5394b80 2709@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2710Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2711deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2712@end table
2713
d4f3574e
SS
2714@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2715@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2716Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2717,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2718subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2719the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2720breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2721breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2722stepping}.)
2723
53a5351d 2724@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2725@subsection Break conditions
2726@cindex conditional breakpoints
2727@cindex breakpoint conditions
2728
2729@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2730@c in particular for a watchpoint?
2731The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2732specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2733breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2734programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2735a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2736and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2737
2738This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2739situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2740when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2741by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2742@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2743
2744Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2745since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2746it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2747and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2748one.
2749
2750Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2751your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2752that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2753format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2754unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2755that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2756program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2757breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2758conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2759purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2760(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2761
2762Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2763@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2764Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2765with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2766
c906108c
SS
2767You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2768The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2769@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2770catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2771
2772@table @code
2773@kindex condition
2774@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2775Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2776watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2777breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2778@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2779@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2780syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2781referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2782symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2783prints an error message:
2784
2785@example
2786No symbol "foo" in current context.
2787@end example
2788
2789@noindent
c906108c
SS
2790@value{GDBN} does
2791not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2792command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2793@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2794
2795@item condition @var{bnum}
2796Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2797an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2798@end table
2799
2800@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2801A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2802breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2803useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2804count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2805is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2806therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2807ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2808the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2809value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
2810your program reaches it.
2811
2812@table @code
2813@kindex ignore
2814@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
2815Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
2816The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
2817execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
2818takes no action.
2819
2820To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
2821a count of zero.
2822
2823When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
2824breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
2825@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
2826Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
2827
2828If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
2829condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
2830@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
2831
2832You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
2833as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
2834is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
2835variables}.
2836@end table
2837
2838Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
2839
2840
53a5351d 2841@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Breakpoint command lists
2843
2844@cindex breakpoint commands
2845You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
2846commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
2847example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
2848enable other breakpoints.
2849
2850@table @code
2851@kindex commands
2852@kindex end
2853@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
2854@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
2855@itemx end
2856Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
2857themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
2858@code{end} to terminate the commands.
2859
2860To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
2861follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
2862
2863With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
2864breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
2865recently encountered).
2866@end table
2867
2868Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
2869disabled within a @var{command-list}.
2870
2871You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
2872use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
2873that resumes execution.
2874
2875Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
2876execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
2877(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
2878another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
2879ambiguities about which list to execute.
2880
2881@kindex silent
2882If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
2883usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
2884be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
2885then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
2886see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
2887meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
2888
2889The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
2890print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
2891breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
2892
2893For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
2894value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
2895
2896@example
2897break foo if x>0
2898commands
2899silent
2900printf "x is %d\n",x
2901cont
2902end
2903@end example
2904
2905One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
2906you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
2907of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
2908erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
2909to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
2910so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
2911command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
2912
2913@example
2914break 403
2915commands
2916silent
2917set x = y + 4
2918cont
2919end
2920@end example
2921
53a5351d 2922@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
2923@subsection Breakpoint menus
2924@cindex overloading
2925@cindex symbol overloading
2926
2927Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
2928to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
2929This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
2930@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
2931a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
2932something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
2933particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
2934you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
2935waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
2936options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
2937sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
2938@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
2939breakpoints.
2940
2941For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
2942breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
2943We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
2944
2945@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
2946@smallexample
2947@group
2948(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
2949[0] cancel
2950[1] all
2951[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
2952[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
2953[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
2954[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
2955[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
2956[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
2957> 2 4 6
2958Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
2959Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
2960Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
2961Multiple breakpoints were set.
2962Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
2963 breakpoints.
2964(@value{GDBP})
2965@end group
2966@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2967
2968@c @ifclear BARETARGET
d4f3574e
SS
2969@node Error in Breakpoints
2970@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2971@c
2972@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
2973@c
d4f3574e
SS
2974Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
2975any other process is running that program. In this situation,
2976attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
2977@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
2978
2979@example
2980Cannot insert breakpoints.
2981The same program may be running in another process.
2982@end example
2983
2984When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
2985
2986@enumerate
2987@item
2988Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
2989
2990@item
2991Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
2992name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
2993that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
2994Then start your program again.
2995
2996@item
2997Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
2998linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
2999to nonsharable executables.
3000@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3001@c @end ifclear
3002
d4f3574e
SS
3003A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3004hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3005
3006@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3007@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3008@smallexample
3009Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3010You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3011@end smallexample
3012
3013@noindent
3014This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3015only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3016watchpoints it needs to insert.
3017
3018When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3019hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3020
3021
53a5351d 3022@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3023@section Continuing and stepping
3024
3025@cindex stepping
3026@cindex continuing
3027@cindex resuming execution
3028@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3029completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3030one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3031line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3032particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3033your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3034it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3035@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3036
3037@table @code
3038@kindex continue
3039@kindex c
3040@kindex fg
3041@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3042@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3043@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3044Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3045any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3046@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3047ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3048@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3049
3050The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3051stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3052@code{continue} is ignored.
3053
d4f3574e
SS
3054The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3055debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3056purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3057@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3058@end table
3059
3060To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3061(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3062calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3063different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3064
3065A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3066(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3067beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3068is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3069and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3070interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3071
3072@table @code
3073@kindex step
3074@kindex s
3075@item step
3076Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3077line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3078abbreviated @code{s}.
3079
3080@quotation
3081@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3082@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3083@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3084@c distinction here.
3085@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3086within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3087execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3088debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3089is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3090without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3091below.
3092@end quotation
3093
d4f3574e
SS
3094The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3095source line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3096switch statements, for loops, etc. @code{step} continues to stop if a
3097function that has debugging information is called within the line.
d4f3574e
SS
3098In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions called
3099within the line.
c906108c 3100
d4f3574e
SS
3101Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3102number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
c906108c
SS
3103@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3104on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3105was any debugging information about the routine.
3106
3107@item step @var{count}
3108Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3109breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3110@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3111
3112@kindex next
3113@kindex n
3114@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3115Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3116This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3117the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3118control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3119that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3120is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3121
3122An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3123
3124
3125@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3126@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3127@c
3128@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3129@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3130@c function are executed without stopping.
3131
d4f3574e
SS
3132The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3133source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
c906108c
SS
3134switch statements, for loops, etc.
3135
3136@kindex finish
3137@item finish
3138Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3139returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3140
3141Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3142,Returning from a function}).
3143
3144@kindex until
3145@kindex u
3146@item until
3147@itemx u
3148Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3149current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3150stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3151command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3152automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3153than the address of the jump.
3154
3155This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3156though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3157exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3158simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3159through the next iteration.
3160
3161@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3162stack frame.
3163
3164@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3165of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3166example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3167(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3168@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3169
3170@example
3171(@value{GDBP}) f
3172#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3173206 expand_input();
3174(@value{GDBP}) until
3175195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3176@end example
3177
3178This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3179generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3180start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3181written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3182to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3183expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3184statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3185
3186@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3187instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3188argument.
3189
3190@item until @var{location}
3191@itemx u @var{location}
3192Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3193reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3194the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3195,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3196and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3197
3198@kindex stepi
3199@kindex si
3200@item stepi
3201@itemx si
3202Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3203
3204It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3205instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3206instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3207Display,, Automatic display}.
3208
3209An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3210
3211@need 750
3212@kindex nexti
3213@kindex ni
3214@item nexti
3215@itemx ni
3216Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3217proceed until the function returns.
3218
3219An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3220@end table
3221
53a5351d 3222@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3223@section Signals
3224@cindex signals
3225
3226A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3227operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3228kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3229signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3230@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3231memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3232the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3233requested an alarm).
3234
3235@cindex fatal signals
3236Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3237functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3238errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3239program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3240@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3241fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3242
3243@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3244program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3245signal.
3246
3247@cindex handling signals
3248Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3249(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3250but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3251You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3252
3253@table @code
3254@kindex info signals
3255@item info signals
3256Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3257handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3258the defined types of signals.
3259
d4f3574e 3260@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3261
3262@kindex handle
3263@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3264Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3265be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3266beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3267@end table
3268
3269@c @group
3270The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3271Their full names are:
3272
3273@table @code
3274@item nostop
3275@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3276still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3277
3278@item stop
3279@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3280the @code{print} keyword as well.
3281
3282@item print
3283@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3284
3285@item noprint
3286@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3287implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3288
3289@item pass
3290@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3291can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3292and not handled.
3293
3294@item nopass
3295@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3296@end table
3297@c @end group
3298
d4f3574e
SS
3299When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3300program until you
c906108c
SS
3301continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3302effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3303after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3304command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3305program sees that signal when you continue.
3306
3307You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3308seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3309or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3310due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3311values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3312execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3313a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3314you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3315program a signal}.
c906108c 3316
53a5351d 3317@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3318@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3319
3320When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3321programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3322breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3323
3324@table @code
3325@cindex breakpoints and threads
3326@cindex thread breakpoints
3327@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3328@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3329@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3330@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3331writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3332
3333Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3334to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3335particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3336numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3337column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3338
3339If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3340breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3341program.
3342
3343You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3344well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3345breakpoint condition, like this:
3346
3347@smallexample
2df3850c 3348(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3349@end smallexample
3350
3351@end table
3352
3353@cindex stopped threads
3354@cindex threads, stopped
3355Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3356@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3357allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3358switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3359underfoot.
3360
3361@cindex continuing threads
3362@cindex threads, continuing
3363Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3364executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3365like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3366
3367In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3368Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3369system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3370execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3371single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3372statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3373stops.
3374
3375You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3376continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3377thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3378first thread completes whatever you requested.
3379
3380On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3381thread to run.
3382
3383@table @code
3384@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3385Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3386locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3387current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3388mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3389``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3390stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3391when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3392function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3393like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3394thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3395@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3396
3397@item show scheduler-locking
3398Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3399@end table
3400
c906108c 3401
53a5351d 3402@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3403@chapter Examining the Stack
3404
3405When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3406stopped and how it got there.
3407
3408@cindex call stack
3409Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3410is generated.
3411That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3412the arguments of the call,
3413and the local variables of the function being called.
3414The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3415The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3416stack}.
3417
3418When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3419stack allow you to see all of this information.
3420
3421@cindex selected frame
3422One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3423@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3424particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3425your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3426special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3427interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3428
3429When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3430currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3431@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3432
3433@menu
3434* Frames:: Stack frames
3435* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3436* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3437* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3438
3439@end menu
3440
53a5351d 3441@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3442@section Stack frames
3443
d4f3574e 3444@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3445@cindex stack frame
3446The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3447frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3448with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3449to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3450which the function is executing.
3451
3452@cindex initial frame
3453@cindex outermost frame
3454@cindex innermost frame
3455When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3456function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3457@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3458made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3459is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3460the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3461actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3462recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3463
3464@cindex frame pointer
3465Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3466stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3467kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3468address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3469in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3470going on in that frame.
3471
3472@cindex frame number
3473@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3474zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3475and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3476they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3477frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3478
3479@c below produces an acceptable overful hbox. --mew 13aug1993
3480@cindex frameless execution
3481Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3482without stack frames. (For example, the @code{@value{GCC}} option
3483@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} generates functions without a frame.)
3484This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3485the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3486with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3487has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3488it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3489correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3490no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3491
3492@table @code
d4f3574e 3493@kindex frame@r{, command}
c906108c
SS
3494@item frame @var{args}
3495The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3496and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3497address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3498@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3499
3500@kindex select-frame
3501@item select-frame
3502The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3503to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3504@code{frame}.
3505@end table
3506
53a5351d 3507@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3508@section Backtraces
3509
3510@cindex backtraces
3511@cindex tracebacks
3512@cindex stack traces
3513A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3514line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3515frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3516stack.
3517
3518@table @code
3519@kindex backtrace
3520@kindex bt
3521@item backtrace
3522@itemx bt
3523Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3524frames in the stack.
3525
3526You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3527character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3528
3529@item backtrace @var{n}
3530@itemx bt @var{n}
3531Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3532
3533@item backtrace -@var{n}
3534@itemx bt -@var{n}
3535Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3536@end table
3537
3538@kindex where
3539@kindex info stack
3540@kindex info s
3541The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3542are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3543
3544Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3545The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3546print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3547line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3548counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3549line number.
3550
3551Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3552@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3553
3554@smallexample
3555@group
3556#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3557 at builtin.c:993
3558#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3559#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3560 at macro.c:71
3561(More stack frames follow...)
3562@end group
3563@end smallexample
3564
3565@noindent
3566The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3567value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3568code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3569
53a5351d 3570@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3571@section Selecting a frame
3572
3573Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3574whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3575selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3576of the stack frame just selected.
3577
3578@table @code
d4f3574e 3579@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
c906108c
SS
3580@kindex f
3581@item frame @var{n}
3582@itemx f @var{n}
3583Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3584(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3585innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3586@code{main}.
3587
3588@item frame @var{addr}
3589@itemx f @var{addr}
3590Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3591chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3592impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3593addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3594switches between them.
3595
c906108c
SS
3596On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3597select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3598
3599On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3600pointer and a program counter.
3601
3602On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3603pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3604@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3605@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3606@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3607
3608@kindex up
3609@item up @var{n}
3610Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3611advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3612that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3613
3614@kindex down
3615@kindex do
3616@item down @var{n}
3617Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3618advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3619that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3620abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3621@end table
3622
3623All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3624frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3625arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3626frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3627
3628@need 1000
3629For example:
3630
3631@smallexample
3632@group
3633(@value{GDBP}) up
3634#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3635 at env.c:10
363610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3637@end group
3638@end smallexample
3639
3640After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3641prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3642@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3643
3644@table @code
3645@kindex down-silently
3646@kindex up-silently
3647@item up-silently @var{n}
3648@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3649These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3650respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3651causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3652in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3653distracting.
3654@end table
3655
53a5351d 3656@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3657@section Information about a frame
3658
3659There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3660stack frame.
3661
3662@table @code
3663@item frame
3664@itemx f
3665When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3666frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3667selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3668argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3669@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3670
3671@kindex info frame
3672@kindex info f
3673@item info frame
3674@itemx info f
3675This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3676including:
3677
3678@itemize @bullet
3679@item
3680the address of the frame
3681@item
3682the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3683@item
3684the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3685@item
3686the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3687@item
3688the address of the frame's arguments
3689@item
d4f3574e
SS
3690the address of the frame's local variables
3691@item
c906108c
SS
3692the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3693@item
3694which registers were saved in the frame
3695@end itemize
3696
3697@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3698something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3699the usual conventions.
3700
3701@item info frame @var{addr}
3702@itemx info f @var{addr}
3703Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3704selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3705command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3706architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3707@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3708
3709@kindex info args
3710@item info args
3711Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3712
3713@item info locals
3714@kindex info locals
3715Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3716line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3717accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3718
c906108c 3719@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3720@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3721@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3722@item info catch
3723Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3724current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3725exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3726@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3727@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3728
c906108c
SS
3729@end table
3730
c906108c 3731
53a5351d 3732@node Source
c906108c
SS
3733@chapter Examining Source Files
3734
3735@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3736information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3737used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3738the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3739(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3740execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3741source files by explicit command.
3742
7a292a7a 3743If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3744prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3745@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3746
3747@menu
3748* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3749* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3750* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3751* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3752@end menu
3753
53a5351d 3754@node List
c906108c
SS
3755@section Printing source lines
3756
3757@kindex list
3758@kindex l
3759To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3760(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3761There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3762
3763Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3764
3765@table @code
3766@item list @var{linenum}
3767Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3768current source file.
3769
3770@item list @var{function}
3771Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3772@var{function}.
3773
3774@item list
3775Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3776@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3777printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3778as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3779Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3780
3781@item list -
3782Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3783@end table
3784
3785By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
3786the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
3787
3788@table @code
3789@kindex set listsize
3790@item set listsize @var{count}
3791Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
3792the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
3793
3794@kindex show listsize
3795@item show listsize
3796Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
3797@end table
3798
3799Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
3800so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
3801than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
3802argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
3803each repetition moves up in the source file.
3804
3805@cindex linespec
3806In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
3807@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 3808of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
3809Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
3810
3811@table @code
3812@item list @var{linespec}
3813Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
3814
3815@item list @var{first},@var{last}
3816Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
3817linespecs.
3818
3819@item list ,@var{last}
3820Print lines ending with @var{last}.
3821
3822@item list @var{first},
3823Print lines starting with @var{first}.
3824
3825@item list +
3826Print lines just after the lines last printed.
3827
3828@item list -
3829Print lines just before the lines last printed.
3830
3831@item list
3832As described in the preceding table.
3833@end table
3834
3835Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
3836kinds of linespec.
3837
3838@table @code
3839@item @var{number}
3840Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
3841When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
3842the same source file as the first linespec.
3843
3844@item +@var{offset}
3845Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
3846When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
3847two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
3848first linespec.
3849
3850@item -@var{offset}
3851Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
3852
3853@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
3854Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
3855
3856@item @var{function}
3857Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
3858For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
3859
3860@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
3861Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
3862function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
3863file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
3864identically named functions in different source files.
3865
3866@item *@var{address}
3867Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
3868@var{address} may be any expression.
3869@end table
3870
53a5351d 3871@node Search
c906108c
SS
3872@section Searching source files
3873@cindex searching
3874@kindex reverse-search
3875
3876There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
3877regular expression.
3878
3879@table @code
3880@kindex search
3881@kindex forward-search
3882@item forward-search @var{regexp}
3883@itemx search @var{regexp}
3884The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
3885starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
3886@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
3887synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
3888@code{fo}.
3889
3890@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
3891The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
3892with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
3893for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
3894this command as @code{rev}.
3895@end table
c906108c 3896
53a5351d 3897@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
3898@section Specifying source directories
3899
3900@cindex source path
3901@cindex directories for source files
3902Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
3903files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
3904the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
3905session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
3906this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
3907it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
3908in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
3909the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
3910the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
3911path.
3912
3913If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
3914object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
3915too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
3916compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
3917last resort.
3918
3919Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
3920any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
3921each line is in the file.
3922
3923@kindex directory
3924@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
3925When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
3926and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
3927To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
3928
3929@table @code
3930@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
3931@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
3932Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
3933directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
3934(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
3935part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
3936whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
3937path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
3938
3939@kindex cdir
3940@kindex cwd
3941@kindex $cdir
3942@kindex $cwd
3943@cindex compilation directory
3944@cindex current directory
3945@cindex working directory
3946@cindex directory, current
3947@cindex directory, compilation
3948You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
3949directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
3950working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
3951tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
3952session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
3953directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
3954
3955@item directory
3956Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
3957
3958@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
3959@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
3960
3961@item show directories
3962@kindex show directories
3963Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
3964@end table
3965
3966If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
3967interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
3968versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
3969
3970@enumerate
3971@item
3972Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
3973
3974@item
3975Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
3976directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
3977directories in one command.
3978@end enumerate
3979
53a5351d 3980@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
3981@section Source and machine code
3982
3983You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
3984addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
3985a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 3986mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
c906108c
SS
3987line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
3988well as hex.
3989
3990@table @code
3991@kindex info line
3992@item info line @var{linespec}
3993Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
3994source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
3995the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
3996source lines}).
3997@end table
3998
3999For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4000the object code for the first line of function
4001@code{m4_changequote}:
4002
d4f3574e
SS
4003@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4004@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c
SS
4005@smallexample
4006(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changecom
4007Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4008@end smallexample
4009
4010@noindent
4011We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4012@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4013@smallexample
4014(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4015Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4016@end smallexample
4017
4018@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
d4f3574e 4019@kindex x@r{, and }@code{info line}
c906108c
SS
4020After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4021is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4022sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4023,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4024convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4025variables}).
4026
4027@table @code
4028@kindex disassemble
4029@cindex assembly instructions
4030@cindex instructions, assembly
4031@cindex machine instructions
4032@cindex listing machine instructions
4033@item disassemble
4034This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4035instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4036program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4037command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4038surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4039(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4040@end table
4041
c906108c
SS
4042The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4043HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4044
4045@smallexample
4046(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4047Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
40480x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
40490x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
40500x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
40510x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
40520x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
40530x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
40540x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
40550x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4056End of assembler dump.
4057@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4058
4059Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4060mnemonics or other syntax.
4061
4062@table @code
d4f3574e 4063@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4064@cindex assembly instructions
4065@cindex instructions, assembly
4066@cindex machine instructions
4067@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4068@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4069@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4070@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4071Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4072program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4073
4074Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4075can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4076The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4077assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4078@end table
4079
4080
53a5351d 4081@node Data
c906108c
SS
4082@chapter Examining Data
4083
4084@cindex printing data
4085@cindex examining data
4086@kindex print
4087@kindex inspect
4088@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4089@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4090@c different window or something like that.
4091The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4092command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4093evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4094program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4095Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4096
4097@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4098@item print @var{expr}
4099@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4100@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4101value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4102you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4103@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4104formats}.
4105
4106@item print
4107@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4108If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4109@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4110conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4111@end table
4112
4113A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4114It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4115specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4116
7a292a7a 4117If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4118fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4119command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4120Table}.
c906108c
SS
4121
4122@menu
4123* Expressions:: Expressions
4124* Variables:: Program variables
4125* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4126* Output Formats:: Output formats
4127* Memory:: Examining memory
4128* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4129* Print Settings:: Print settings
4130* Value History:: Value history
4131* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4132* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4133* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
c906108c
SS
4134@end menu
4135
53a5351d 4136@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4137@section Expressions
4138
4139@cindex expressions
4140@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4141compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4142by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4143@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4144and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4145by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4146
d4f3574e
SS
4147@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4148the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4149you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4150memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4151
c906108c
SS
4152Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4153this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4154Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4155languages.
4156
4157In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4158expressions regardless of your programming language.
4159
4160Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4161useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4162at that address in memory.
4163@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4164
4165@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4166to programming languages:
4167
4168@table @code
4169@item @@
4170@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4171@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4172
4173@item ::
4174@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4175function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4176
4177@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4178@cindex type casting memory
4179@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4180@cindex casts, to view memory
4181@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4182Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4183memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4184pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4185a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4186normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4187@end table
4188
53a5351d 4189@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4190@section Program variables
4191
4192The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4193in your program.
4194
4195Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4196(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4197
4198@itemize @bullet
4199@item
4200global (or file-static)
4201@end itemize
4202
4203@noindent or
4204
4205@itemize @bullet
4206@item
4207visible according to the scope rules of the
4208programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4209@end itemize
4210
4211@noindent This means that in the function
4212
4213@example
4214foo (a)
4215 int a;
4216@{
4217 bar (a);
4218 @{
4219 int b = test ();
4220 bar (b);
4221 @}
4222@}
4223@end example
4224
4225@noindent
4226you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4227executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4228examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4229the block where @code{b} is declared.
4230
4231@cindex variable name conflict
4232There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4233scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4234in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4235function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4236happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4237you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4238using the colon-colon notation:
4239
d4f3574e 4240@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4241@iftex
4242@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4243@kindex ::
4244@end iftex
4245@example
4246@var{file}::@var{variable}
4247@var{function}::@var{variable}
4248@end example
4249
4250@noindent
4251Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4252static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4253make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4254to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4255
4256@example
4257(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4258@end example
4259
c906108c
SS
4260@cindex C++ scope resolution
4261This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4262use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4263scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4264@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4265@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4266
4267@cindex wrong values
4268@cindex variable values, wrong
4269@quotation
4270@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4271wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4272scope, and just before exit.
4273@end quotation
4274You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4275This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4276set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4277stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4278values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4279also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4280after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4281variable definitions may be gone.
4282
4283This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4284To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4285when compiling.
4286
d4f3574e
SS
4287@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4288Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4289unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4290opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4291offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4292might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4293happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4294
4295@example
4296No symbol "foo" in current context.
4297@end example
4298
4299To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4300different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4301formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4302supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4303in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4304to use DWARF-2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4305debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4306Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4307information.
4308
4309
53a5351d 4310@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4311@section Artificial arrays
4312
4313@cindex artificial array
4314@kindex @@
4315It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4316same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4317dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4318program.
4319
4320You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4321@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4322operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4323and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4324of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4325the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4326argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4327following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4328example. If a program says
4329
4330@example
4331int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4332@end example
4333
4334@noindent
4335you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4336
4337@example
4338p *array@@len
4339@end example
4340
4341The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4342with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4343subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4344Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4345(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4346
4347Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4348This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4349The value need not be in memory:
4350@example
4351(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4352$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4353@end example
4354
4355As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4356@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4357the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4358@example
4359(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4360$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4361@end example
4362
4363Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4364moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4365actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4366of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4367to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4368variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4369interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4370instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4371structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4372in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4373
4374@example
4375set $i = 0
4376p dtab[$i++]->fv
4377@key{RET}
4378@key{RET}
4379@dots{}
4380@end example
4381
53a5351d 4382@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4383@section Output formats
4384
4385@cindex formatted output
4386@cindex output formats
4387By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4388this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4389in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4390at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4391these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4392
4393The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4394already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4395@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4396letters supported are:
4397
4398@table @code
4399@item x
4400Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4401hexadecimal.
4402
4403@item d
4404Print as integer in signed decimal.
4405
4406@item u
4407Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4408
4409@item o
4410Print as integer in octal.
4411
4412@item t
4413Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4414@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4415used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4416see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4417
4418@item a
4419@cindex unknown address, locating
4420Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4421the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4422where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4423
4424@example
4425(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4426$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4427@end example
4428
4429@item c
4430Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4431
4432@item f
4433Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4434using typical floating point syntax.
4435@end table
4436
4437For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4438
4439@example
4440p/x $pc
4441@end example
4442
4443@noindent
4444Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4445names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4446
4447To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4448you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4449expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4450
53a5351d 4451@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4452@section Examining memory
4453
4454You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4455any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4456
4457@cindex examining memory
4458@table @code
4459@kindex x
4460@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4461@itemx x @var{addr}
4462@itemx x
4463Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4464@end table
4465
4466@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4467much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4468expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4469If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4470Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4471
4472@table @r
4473@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4474The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4475how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4476@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4477@c 4.1.2.
4478
4479@item @var{f}, the display format
4480The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4481@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4482The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4483The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4484
4485@item @var{u}, the unit size
4486The unit size is any of
4487
4488@table @code
4489@item b
4490Bytes.
4491@item h
4492Halfwords (two bytes).
4493@item w
4494Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4495@item g
4496Giant words (eight bytes).
4497@end table
4498
4499Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4500default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4501@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4502
4503@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4504@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4505memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4506it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4507@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4508@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4509other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4510the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4511starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4512a value from memory).
4513@end table
4514
4515For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4516(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4517starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4518words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4519@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4520
4521Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4522letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4523unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4524specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4525(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4526
4527Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4528and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4529@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4530including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4531alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4532Code,,Source and machine code}.
4533
4534All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4535easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4536you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4537instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4538with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4539the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4540for successive uses of @code{x}.
4541
4542@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4543The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4544in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4545would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4546subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4547@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4548examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4549@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4550the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4551
4552If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4553are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4554address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4555
53a5351d 4556@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4557@section Automatic display
4558@cindex automatic display
4559@cindex display of expressions
4560
4561If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4562(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4563display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4564Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4565to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4566The automatic display looks like this:
4567
4568@example
45692: foo = 38
45703: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4571@end example
4572
4573@noindent
4574This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4575displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4576specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4577whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4578format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4579or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4580supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4581
4582@table @code
4583@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4584@item display @var{expr}
4585Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4586each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4587
4588@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4589
d4f3574e 4590@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4591For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4592count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4593arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4594@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4595
4596@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4597For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4598number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4599be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4600doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4601@end table
4602
4603For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4604instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4605is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4606
4607@table @code
4608@kindex delete display
4609@kindex undisplay
4610@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4611@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4612Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4613
4614@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4615(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4616
4617@kindex disable display
4618@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4619Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4620item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4621enabled again later.
4622
4623@kindex enable display
4624@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4625Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4626again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4627
4628@item display
4629Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4630done when your program stops.
4631
4632@kindex info display
4633@item info display
4634Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4635automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4636values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4637It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4638because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4639@end table
4640
4641If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4642sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4643expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4644variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4645@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4646@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4647continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4648there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4649automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4650is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4651
53a5351d 4652@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4653@section Print settings
4654
4655@cindex format options
4656@cindex print settings
4657@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4658and symbols are printed.
4659
4660@noindent
4661These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4662
4663@table @code
4664@kindex set print address
4665@item set print address
4666@itemx set print address on
4667@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4668traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4669even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4670is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4671@code{set print address on}:
4672
4673@smallexample
4674@group
4675(@value{GDBP}) f
4676#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4677 at input.c:530
4678530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4679@end group
4680@end smallexample
4681
4682@item set print address off
4683Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4684this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4685
4686@smallexample
4687@group
4688(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4689(@value{GDBP}) f
4690#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4691530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4692@end group
4693@end smallexample
4694
4695You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4696dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4697@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4698all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4699
4700@kindex show print address
4701@item show print address
4702Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4703@end table
4704
4705When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4706closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4707identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4708source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4709@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4710you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4711it prints a symbolic address:
4712
4713@table @code
4714@kindex set print symbol-filename
4715@item set print symbol-filename on
4716Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4717symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4718
4719@item set print symbol-filename off
4720Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4721default.
4722
4723@kindex show print symbol-filename
4724@item show print symbol-filename
4725Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4726line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4727@end table
4728
4729Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4730numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4731number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4732
4733Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4734printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4735
4736@table @code
4737@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4738@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4739Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4740offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4741@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4742to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4743
4744@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4745@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4746Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4747symbolic address.
4748@end table
4749
4750@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4751@cindex pointer, finding referent
4752If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4753@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4754and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4755@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4756For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4757at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4758
4759@example
4760(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4761(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4762$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4763@end example
4764
4765@quotation
4766@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4767does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4768the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4769@end quotation
4770
4771Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4772
4773@table @code
4774@kindex set print array
4775@item set print array
4776@itemx set print array on
4777Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4778but uses more space. The default is off.
4779
4780@item set print array off
4781Return to compressed format for arrays.
4782
4783@kindex show print array
4784@item show print array
4785Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
4786arrays.
4787
4788@kindex set print elements
4789@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
4790Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
4791If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
4792printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
4793This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 4794When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
4795Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
4796
4797@kindex show print elements
4798@item show print elements
4799Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
4800If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
4801
4802@kindex set print null-stop
4803@item set print null-stop
4804Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 4805@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 4806contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 4807The default is off.
c906108c
SS
4808
4809@kindex set print pretty
4810@item set print pretty on
4811Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
4812per line, like this:
4813
4814@smallexample
4815@group
4816$1 = @{
4817 next = 0x0,
4818 flags = @{
4819 sweet = 1,
4820 sour = 1
4821 @},
4822 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
4823@}
4824@end group
4825@end smallexample
4826
4827@item set print pretty off
4828Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
4829
4830@smallexample
4831@group
4832$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
4833meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
4834@end group
4835@end smallexample
4836
4837@noindent
4838This is the default format.
4839
4840@kindex show print pretty
4841@item show print pretty
4842Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
4843
4844@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
4845@item set print sevenbit-strings on
4846Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
4847@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
4848character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
4849best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
4850high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
4851
4852@item set print sevenbit-strings off
4853Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
4854international character sets, and is the default.
4855
4856@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
4857@item show print sevenbit-strings
4858Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
4859
4860@kindex set print union
4861@item set print union on
4862Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
4863is the default setting.
4864
4865@item set print union off
4866Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
4867
4868@kindex show print union
4869@item show print union
4870Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
4871structures.
4872
4873For example, given the declarations
4874
4875@smallexample
4876typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
4877typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
4878typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
4879 Bug_forms;
4880
4881struct thing @{
4882 Species it;
4883 union @{
4884 Tree_forms tree;
4885 Bug_forms bug;
4886 @} form;
4887@};
4888
4889struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
4890@end smallexample
4891
4892@noindent
4893with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
4894
4895@smallexample
4896$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
4897@end smallexample
4898
4899@noindent
4900and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
4901
4902@smallexample
4903$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
4904@end smallexample
4905@end table
4906
c906108c
SS
4907@need 1000
4908@noindent
4909These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
4910
4911@table @code
4912@cindex demangling
4913@kindex set print demangle
4914@item set print demangle
4915@itemx set print demangle on
4916Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
4917(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 4918linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
4919
4920@kindex show print demangle
4921@item show print demangle
4922Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
4923
4924@kindex set print asm-demangle
4925@item set print asm-demangle
4926@itemx set print asm-demangle on
4927Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
4928in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
4929The default is off.
4930
4931@kindex show print asm-demangle
4932@item show print asm-demangle
4933Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
4934or demangled form.
4935
4936@kindex set demangle-style
4937@cindex C++ symbol decoding style
4938@cindex symbol decoding style, C++
4939@item set demangle-style @var{style}
4940Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
4941represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
4942
4943@table @code
4944@item auto
4945Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
4946
4947@item gnu
4948Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 4949This is the default.
c906108c
SS
4950
4951@item hp
4952Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
4953
4954@item lucid
4955Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
4956
4957@item arm
4958Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
4959@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
4960debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
4961require further enhancement to permit that.
4962
4963@end table
4964If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
4965
4966@kindex show demangle-style
4967@item show demangle-style
4968Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
4969
4970@kindex set print object
4971@item set print object
4972@itemx set print object on
4973When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
4974(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
4975the virtual function table.
4976
4977@item set print object off
4978Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
4979virtual function table. This is the default setting.
4980
4981@kindex show print object
4982@item show print object
4983Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
4984
4985@kindex set print static-members
4986@item set print static-members
4987@itemx set print static-members on
4988Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
4989
4990@item set print static-members off
4991Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
4992
4993@kindex show print static-members
4994@item show print static-members
4995Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
4996
4997@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
4998@kindex set print vtbl
4999@item set print vtbl
5000@itemx set print vtbl on
5001Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5002(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5003ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5004
5005@item set print vtbl off
5006Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5007
5008@kindex show print vtbl
5009@item show print vtbl
5010Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5011@end table
c906108c 5012
53a5351d 5013@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5014@section Value history
5015
5016@cindex value history
5017Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5018@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5019Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5020(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5021When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5022since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5023symbol table.
5024
5025@cindex @code{$}
5026@cindex @code{$$}
5027@cindex history number
5028The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5029refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5030@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5031printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5032history number.
5033
5034To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5035history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5036remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5037the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5038@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5039is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5040@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5041
5042For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5043want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5044
5045@example
5046p *$
5047@end example
5048
5049If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5050to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5051
5052@example
5053p *$.next
5054@end example
5055
5056@noindent
5057You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5058command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5059
5060Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5061@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5062
5063@example
5064print x
5065set x=5
5066@end example
5067
5068@noindent
5069then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5070remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5071
5072@table @code
5073@kindex show values
5074@item show values
5075Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5076This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5077values} does not change the history.
5078
5079@item show values @var{n}
5080Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5081
5082@item show values +
5083Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5084values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5085@end table
5086
5087Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5088same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5089
53a5351d 5090@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5091@section Convenience variables
5092
5093@cindex convenience variables
5094@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5095@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5096exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5097setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5098of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5099
5100Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5101@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5102the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5103(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5104by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5105
5106You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5107expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5108For example:
5109
5110@example
5111set $foo = *object_ptr
5112@end example
5113
5114@noindent
5115would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5116@code{object_ptr}.
5117
5118Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5119value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5120value with another assignment at any time.
5121
5122Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5123variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5124that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5125variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5126
5127@table @code
5128@kindex show convenience
5129@item show convenience
5130Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5131Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5132@end table
5133
5134One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5135incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5136a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5137
5138@example
5139set $i = 0
5140print bar[$i++]->contents
5141@end example
5142
d4f3574e
SS
5143@noindent
5144Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5145
5146Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5147values likely to be useful.
5148
5149@table @code
5150@kindex $_
5151@item $_
5152The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5153the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5154commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5155set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5156and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5157except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5158to the type of @code{$__}.
5159
5160@kindex $__
5161@item $__
5162The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5163to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5164to match the format in which the data was printed.
5165
5166@item $_exitcode
5167@kindex $_exitcode
5168The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5169the program being debugged terminates.
5170@end table
5171
53a5351d
JM
5172On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5173begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5174name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5175
53a5351d 5176@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5177@section Registers
5178
5179@cindex registers
5180You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5181with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5182for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5183your machine.
5184
5185@table @code
5186@kindex info registers
5187@item info registers
5188Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5189registers (in the selected stack frame).
5190
5191@kindex info all-registers
5192@cindex floating point registers
5193@item info all-registers
5194Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5195registers.
5196
5197@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5198Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5199As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5200the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5201the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5202@end table
5203
5204@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5205expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5206architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5207@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5208the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5209pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5210register that contains the processor status. For example,
5211you could print the program counter in hex with
5212
5213@example
5214p/x $pc
5215@end example
5216
5217@noindent
5218or print the instruction to be executed next with
5219
5220@example
5221x/i $pc
5222@end example
5223
5224@noindent
5225or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5226one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5227memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5228stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5229stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5230regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5231see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5232
5233@example
5234set $sp += 4
5235@end example
5236
5237Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5238your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5239so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5240shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5241registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5242can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5243is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5244
5245@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5246integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5247special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5248registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5249to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5250(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5251@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5252
5253Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5254means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5255the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5256sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5257coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5258programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5259cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5260that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5261prints the data in both formats.
5262
5263Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5264(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5265value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5266were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5267true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5268frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5269
5270However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5271code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5272@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5273frame makes no difference.
5274
53a5351d 5275@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5276@section Floating point hardware
5277@cindex floating point
5278
5279Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5280you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5281
5282@table @code
5283@kindex info float
5284@item info float
5285Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5286point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5287floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5288the ARM and x86 machines.
5289@end table
c906108c 5290
53a5351d 5291@node Languages
c906108c
SS
5292@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5293@cindex languages
5294
c906108c
SS
5295Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5296rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5297dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5298Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5299represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5300@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
5301
5302@cindex working language
5303Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5304allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5305native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5306consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5307language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5308language}.
5309
5310@menu
5311* Setting:: Switching between source languages
5312* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 5313* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5314* Support:: Supported languages
5315@end menu
5316
53a5351d 5317@node Setting
c906108c
SS
5318@section Switching between source languages
5319
5320There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5321set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5322@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5323defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5324used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5325are printed, etc.
5326
5327In addition to the working language, every source file that
5328@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5329file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5330source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5331language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5332controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5333show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
5334set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5335set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5336Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
5337
5338This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5339as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5340another language. In that case, make the
5341program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5342@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5343program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5344
5345@menu
5346* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5347* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5348* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5349@end menu
5350
53a5351d 5351@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
5352@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5353
5354If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5355@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5356
5357@table @file
5358
5359@item .c
5360C source file
5361
5362@item .C
5363@itemx .cc
5364@itemx .cp
5365@itemx .cpp
5366@itemx .cxx
5367@itemx .c++
5368C++ source file
5369
5370@item .f
5371@itemx .F
5372Fortran source file
5373
c906108c
SS
5374@item .ch
5375@itemx .c186
5376@itemx .c286
5377CHILL source file.
c906108c 5378
c906108c
SS
5379@item .mod
5380Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
5381
5382@item .s
5383@itemx .S
5384Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5385@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5386@end table
5387
5388In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5389extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5390
53a5351d 5391@node Manually
c906108c
SS
5392@subsection Setting the working language
5393
5394If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5395expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5396your program.
5397
5398@kindex set language
5399If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5400command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5401a language, such as
c906108c 5402@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
5403For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5404
c906108c
SS
5405Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5406language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5407to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5408source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5409languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5410source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5411command such as:
5412
5413@example
5414print a = b + c
5415@end example
5416
5417@noindent
5418might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5419@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5420printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5421@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 5422
53a5351d 5423@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
5424@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5425
5426To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5427@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5428then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5429frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5430working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5431frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5432or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5433does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5434not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5435
5436This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5437entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5438written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5439a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5440case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5441
53a5351d 5442@node Show
c906108c 5443@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
5444
5445The following commands help you find out which language is the
5446working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5447
5448@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
5449@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5450@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
5451@table @code
5452@item show language
5453Display the current working language. This is the
5454language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5455build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5456
5457@item info frame
5458Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5459working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5460@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5461information listed here.
5462
5463@item info source
5464Display the source language of this source file.
5465@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5466information listed here.
5467@end table
5468
5469In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5470not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5471with a language explicitly:
5472
5473@kindex set extension-language
5474@kindex info extensions
5475@table @code
5476@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5477Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5478the source language @var{language}.
5479
5480@item info extensions
5481List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5482@end table
5483
53a5351d 5484@node Checks
c906108c
SS
5485@section Type and range checking
5486
5487@quotation
5488@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5489checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5490section documents the intended facilities.
5491@end quotation
5492@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5493
5494Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5495errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5496checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5497sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5498these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5499by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5500errors when your program is running.
5501
5502@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5503Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5504can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5505the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5506@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5507your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5508for the default settings of supported languages.
5509
5510@menu
5511* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5512* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5513@end menu
5514
5515@cindex type checking
5516@cindex checks, type
53a5351d 5517@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
5518@subsection An overview of type checking
5519
5520Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5521arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5522otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5523errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5524
5525@smallexample
55261 + 2 @result{} 3
5527@exdent but
5528@error{} 1 + 2.3
5529@end smallexample
5530
5531The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5532type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5533
5534For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5535@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5536to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5537or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5538but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5539these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5540also issues a warning.
5541
5542Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5543related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5544For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5545a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5546with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5547the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5548
5549Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5550instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5551operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5552represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5553operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5554details on specific languages.
5555
5556@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5557
d4f3574e 5558@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
5559@kindex set check type
5560@kindex show check type
5561@table @code
5562@item set check type auto
5563Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5564@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5565each language.
5566
5567@item set check type on
5568@itemx set check type off
5569Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5570current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5571match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 5572evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
5573message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5574
5575@item set check type warn
5576Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5577evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5578be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5579numbers and structures.
5580
5581@item show type
5582Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5583is setting it automatically.
5584@end table
5585
5586@cindex range checking
5587@cindex checks, range
53a5351d 5588@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
5589@subsection An overview of range checking
5590
5591In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5592bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5593checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5594computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5595not exceed the bounds of the array.
5596
5597For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5598@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5599always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5600warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5601
5602A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5603array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5604of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5605error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5606result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5607the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5608
5609@example
5610@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5611@end example
5612
5613This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5614specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5615Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5616
5617@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5618
d4f3574e 5619@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
5620@kindex set check range
5621@kindex show check range
5622@table @code
5623@item set check range auto
5624Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5625@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5626each language.
5627
5628@item set check range on
5629@itemx set check range off
5630Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5631current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
5632match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5633then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
5634
5635@item set check range warn
5636Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5637but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5638expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5639memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5640systems).
5641
5642@item show range
5643Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5644being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5645@end table
c906108c 5646
53a5351d 5647@node Support
c906108c 5648@section Supported languages
c906108c 5649
cce74817
JM
5650@value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
5651@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
5652Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
5653language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
5654and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
5655,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
5656language.
5657
5658The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
5659supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
5660tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
5661@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
5662formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
5663books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
5664language reference or tutorial.
5665
c906108c 5666@menu
7a292a7a 5667* C:: C and C++
cce74817 5668* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 5669* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
5670@end menu
5671
53a5351d 5672@node C
c906108c 5673@subsection C and C++
7a292a7a 5674
c906108c
SS
5675@cindex C and C++
5676@cindex expressions in C or C++
c906108c
SS
5677
5678Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
5679to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
5680together.
5681
c906108c
SS
5682@cindex C++
5683@kindex g++
5684@cindex @sc{gnu} C++
5685The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
5686compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
5687effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
5688C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
5689compiler (@code{aCC}).
5690
5691For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
5692format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
5693command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
5694@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
5695CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 5696
c906108c
SS
5697@menu
5698* C Operators:: C and C++ operators
5699* C Constants:: C and C++ constants
7a292a7a 5700* C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
c906108c 5701* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
c906108c 5702* C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
c906108c
SS
5703* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
5704* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
5705@end menu
c906108c 5706
53a5351d 5707@node C Operators
c906108c 5708@subsubsection C and C++ operators
7a292a7a
SS
5709
5710@cindex C and C++ operators
c906108c
SS
5711
5712Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
5713@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5714often defined on groups of types.
5715
c906108c 5716For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
5717
5718@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 5719
c906108c 5720@item
c906108c
SS
5721@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
5722specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
5723
5724@item
d4f3574e
SS
5725@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
5726@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
5727
5728@item
53a5351d 5729@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
5730
5731@item
5732@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 5733
c906108c
SS
5734@end itemize
5735
5736@noindent
5737The following operators are supported. They are listed here
5738in order of increasing precedence:
5739
5740@table @code
5741@item ,
5742The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
5743are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
5744expression being the last expression evaluated.
5745
5746@item =
5747Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
5748assigned. Defined on scalar types.
5749
5750@item @var{op}=
5751Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
5752and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 5753@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
5754@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
5755@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
5756
5757@item ?:
5758The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
5759of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
5760integral type.
5761
5762@item ||
5763Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5764
5765@item &&
5766Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5767
5768@item |
5769Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5770
5771@item ^
5772Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
5773
5774@item &
5775Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
5776
5777@item ==@r{, }!=
5778Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
5779expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
5780
5781@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
5782Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
5783Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
5784and non-zero for true.
5785
5786@item <<@r{, }>>
5787left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
5788
5789@item @@
5790The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
5791
5792@item +@r{, }-
5793Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
5794pointer types.
5795
5796@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
5797Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
5798defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
5799integral types.
5800
5801@item ++@r{, }--
5802Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
5803operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
5804when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
5805operation takes place.
5806
5807@item *
5808Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
5809@code{++}.
5810
5811@item &
5812Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
5813
c906108c
SS
5814For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
5815allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
5816(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
5817where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
5818stored.
c906108c
SS
5819
5820@item -
5821Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
5822precedence as @code{++}.
5823
5824@item !
5825Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5826@code{++}.
5827
5828@item ~
5829Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
5830@code{++}.
5831
5832
5833@item .@r{, }->
5834Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
5835@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
5836pointer based on the stored type information.
5837Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
5838
c906108c
SS
5839@item .*@r{, }->*
5840Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
5841
5842@item []
5843Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
5844@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5845
5846@item ()
5847Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
5848
c906108c 5849@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5850C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
5851and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
5852
5853@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
5854Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
5855(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
5856above.
c906108c
SS
5857@end table
5858
c906108c
SS
5859If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
5860attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
5861predefined meaning.
c906108c 5862
c906108c
SS
5863@menu
5864* C Constants::
5865@end menu
5866
53a5351d 5867@node C Constants
c906108c 5868@subsubsection C and C++ constants
c906108c
SS
5869
5870@cindex C and C++ constants
c906108c 5871
7a292a7a 5872@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
c906108c 5873following ways:
c906108c
SS
5874
5875@itemize @bullet
5876@item
5877Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
5878specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
5879a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
5880@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
5881@code{long} value.
5882
5883@item
5884Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
5885point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
5886exponent. An exponent is of the form:
5887@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
5888sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
5889A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
5890@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
5891the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
5892a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
5893constant.
c906108c
SS
5894
5895@item
5896Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
5897integral equivalents.
5898
5899@item
5900Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
5901(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 5902(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
5903be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
5904the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
5905of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
5906@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
5907@samp{\n} for newline.
5908
5909@item
5910String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded
5911by double quotes (@code{"}).
5912
5913@item
5914Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
5915to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
5916
5917@item
5918Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
5919and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
5920integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
5921and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
5922@end itemize
5923
c906108c 5924@menu
7a292a7a 5925* C plus plus expressions::
c906108c 5926* C Defaults::
c906108c 5927* C Checks::
c906108c
SS
5928
5929* Debugging C::
5930@end menu
5931
53a5351d 5932@node C plus plus expressions
c906108c 5933@subsubsection C++ expressions
c906108c
SS
5934
5935@cindex expressions in C++
5936@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
5937
c906108c
SS
5938@cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
5939@cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
5940@cindex C++ and object formats
5941@cindex object formats and C++
5942@cindex a.out and C++
5943@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
5944@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
5945@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
5946@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
5947@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
5948@c periodically whether this has happened...
5949@quotation
5950@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
5951proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
5952additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
5953special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
5954@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
5955symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
5956you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
5957extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
5958@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
5959support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
5960@end quotation
c906108c
SS
5961
5962@enumerate
5963
5964@cindex member functions
5965@item
5966Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
5967
5968@example
5969count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
5970@end example
5971
5972@kindex this
5973@cindex namespace in C++
5974@item
5975While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
5976expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
5977that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
5978pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
5979
c906108c 5980@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 5981@cindex overloaded functions, calling
c906108c
SS
5982@cindex type conversions in C++
5983@item
5984You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 5985call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
5986perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
5987calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
5988in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
5989default arguments.
5990
5991It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
5992promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
5993class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
5994functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
5995number of function arguments.
5996
5997Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
5998@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
5999,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6000
d4f3574e 6001You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6002explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6003@smallexample
6004p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6005@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6006
c906108c 6007The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6008see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6009
c906108c
SS
6010@cindex reference declarations
6011@item
6012@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6013them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6014dereferenced.
6015
6016In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6017reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6018avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6019The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6020you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6021
6022@item
6023@value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6024expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6025one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6026necessary, for example in an expression like
6027@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6028resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6029debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6030@end enumerate
6031
53a5351d
JM
6032In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6033calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6034objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6035invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 6036
53a5351d 6037@node C Defaults
c906108c 6038@subsubsection C and C++ defaults
7a292a7a 6039
c906108c
SS
6040@cindex C and C++ defaults
6041
c906108c
SS
6042If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6043both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6044C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6045selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
6046
6047If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6048recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6049@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6050these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6051@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6052for further details.
6053
c906108c
SS
6054@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6055@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6056@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 6057
53a5351d 6058@node C Checks
c906108c 6059@subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
7a292a7a 6060
c906108c
SS
6061@cindex C and C++ checks
6062
6063By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6064is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6065considers two variables type equivalent if:
6066
6067@itemize @bullet
6068@item
6069The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6070enumerated tag.
6071
6072@item
6073The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6074declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6075
6076@ignore
6077@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6078@c FIXME--beers?
6079@item
6080The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6081declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6082compilers.)
6083@end ignore
6084@end itemize
6085
6086Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6087indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6088that is not itself an array.
c906108c 6089
53a5351d 6090@node Debugging C
c906108c 6091@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
6092
6093The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6094the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
6095inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6096appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
6097
6098The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6099with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6100,Expressions}.
6101
c906108c
SS
6102@menu
6103* Debugging C plus plus::
6104@end menu
6105
53a5351d 6106@node Debugging C plus plus
c906108c 6107@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
c906108c
SS
6108
6109@cindex commands for C++
7a292a7a 6110
c906108c
SS
6111Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6112designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6113
6114@table @code
6115@cindex break in overloaded functions
6116@item @r{breakpoint menus}
6117When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6118@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6119you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6120
6121@cindex overloading in C++
6122@item rbreak @var{regex}
6123Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6124breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6125classes.
6126@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6127
6128@cindex C++ exception handling
6129@item catch throw
6130@itemx catch catch
6131Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6132Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6133
6134@cindex inheritance
6135@item ptype @var{typename}
6136Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6137@var{typename}.
6138@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6139
6140@cindex C++ symbol display
6141@item set print demangle
6142@itemx show print demangle
6143@itemx set print asm-demangle
6144@itemx show print asm-demangle
6145Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6146displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6147@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6148
6149@item set print object
6150@itemx show print object
6151Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6152@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6153
6154@item set print vtbl
6155@itemx show print vtbl
6156Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6157@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c
SS
6158(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6159ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6160
6161@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 6162@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c
SS
6163@item set overload-resolution on
6164Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6165is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6166and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
d4f3574e
SS
6167using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6168expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
6169message.
6170
6171@item set overload-resolution off
6172Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6173overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6174chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6175symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6176overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6177searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6178argument types.
c906108c
SS
6179
6180@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6181You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6182the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6183@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6184also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6185available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6186@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6187@end table
c906108c 6188
53a5351d 6189@node Modula-2
c906108c 6190@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 6191
d4f3574e 6192@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
6193
6194The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6195output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6196developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6197attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6198to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6199table.
6200
6201@cindex expressions in Modula-2
6202@menu
6203* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6204* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6205* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6206* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6207* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6208* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6209* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6210* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6211@end menu
6212
53a5351d 6213@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
6214@subsubsection Operators
6215@cindex Modula-2 operators
6216
6217Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6218@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6219often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6220following definitions hold:
6221
6222@itemize @bullet
6223
6224@item
6225@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6226their subranges.
6227
6228@item
6229@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6230
6231@item
6232@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6233
6234@item
6235@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6236@var{type}}.
6237
6238@item
6239@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6240
6241@item
6242@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6243
6244@item
6245@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6246@end itemize
6247
6248@noindent
6249The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6250increasing precedence:
6251
6252@table @code
6253@item ,
6254Function argument or array index separator.
6255
6256@item :=
6257Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6258@var{value}.
6259
6260@item <@r{, }>
6261Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6262types.
6263
6264@item <=@r{, }>=
6265Less than, greater than, less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6266on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6267set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6268
6269@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6270Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6271Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6272available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6273comment character.
6274
6275@item IN
6276Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6277Same precedence as @code{<}.
6278
6279@item OR
6280Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6281
6282@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 6283Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
6284
6285@item @@
6286The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6287
6288@item +@r{, }-
6289Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6290and difference on set types.
6291
6292@item *
6293Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6294on set types.
6295
6296@item /
6297Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6298types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6299
6300@item DIV@r{, }MOD
6301Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6302precedence as @code{*}.
6303
6304@item -
6305Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6306
6307@item ^
6308Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6309
6310@item NOT
6311Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6312@code{^}.
6313
6314@item .
6315@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6316precedence as @code{^}.
6317
6318@item []
6319Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6320
6321@item ()
6322Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6323as @code{^}.
6324
6325@item ::@r{, }.
6326@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6327@end table
6328
6329@quotation
6330@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6331treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6332@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6333@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6334@end quotation
6335
6336@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
53a5351d 6337@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
6338@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6339
6340Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6341In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6342
6343@table @var
6344
6345@item a
6346represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6347
6348@item c
6349represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6350
6351@item i
6352represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6353
6354@item m
6355represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6356same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6357be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6358
6359@item n
6360represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6361
6362@item r
6363represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6364
6365@item t
6366represents a type.
6367
6368@item v
6369represents a variable.
6370
6371@item x
6372represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6373explanation of the function for details.
6374@end table
6375
6376All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6377
6378@table @code
6379@item ABS(@var{n})
6380Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6381
6382@item CAP(@var{c})
6383If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 6384equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
6385
6386@item CHR(@var{i})
6387Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6388
6389@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6390Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6391
6392@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6393Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6394new value.
6395
6396@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6397Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6398set.
6399
6400@item FLOAT(@var{i})
6401Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6402
6403@item HIGH(@var{a})
6404Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6405
6406@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 6407Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
6408
6409@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6410Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6411new value.
6412
6413@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6414Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6415there. Returns the new set.
6416
6417@item MAX(@var{t})
6418Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6419
6420@item MIN(@var{t})
6421Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6422
6423@item ODD(@var{i})
6424Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6425
6426@item ORD(@var{x})
6427Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
6428value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6429@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
6430integral, character and enumerated types.
6431
6432@item SIZE(@var{x})
6433Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6434
6435@item TRUNC(@var{r})
6436Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6437
6438@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6439Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6440@end table
6441
6442@quotation
6443@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6444@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6445an error.
6446@end quotation
6447
6448@cindex Modula-2 constants
53a5351d 6449@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
6450@subsubsection Constants
6451
6452@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6453ways:
6454
6455@itemize @bullet
6456
6457@item
6458Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6459expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6460rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6461trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6462
6463@item
6464Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6465decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6466then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6467@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6468digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6469digits.
6470
6471@item
6472Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6473like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 6474also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
6475followed by a @samp{C}.
6476
6477@item
6478String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6479pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6480Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6481Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6482sequences.
6483
6484@item
6485Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6486
6487@item
6488Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6489@code{FALSE}.
6490
6491@item
6492Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6493
6494@item
6495Set constants are not yet supported.
6496@end itemize
6497
53a5351d 6498@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
6499@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6500@cindex Modula-2 defaults
6501
6502If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6503both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 6504Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6505selected the working language.
6506
6507If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6508code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 6509working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
6510the language automatically}, for further details.
6511
53a5351d 6512@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
6513@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6514@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6515
6516A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6517This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6518
6519@itemize @bullet
6520@item
6521Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6522integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6523debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6524pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6525through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6526returned a pointer.)
6527
6528@item
6529C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6530non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6531escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6532printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6533
6534@item
6535The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6536argument.
6537
6538@item
6539All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6540@end itemize
6541
53a5351d 6542@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
6543@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6544@cindex Modula-2 checks
6545
6546@quotation
6547@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6548range checking.
6549@end quotation
6550@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6551
6552@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6553
6554@itemize @bullet
6555@item
6556They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6557@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6558
6559@item
6560They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6561@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6562@end itemize
6563
6564As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6565whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6566
6567Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6568index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6569
53a5351d 6570@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
6571@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6572@cindex scope
6573@kindex .
6574@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6575@ifinfo
d4f3574e 6576@kindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
6577@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6578@end ifinfo
6579@iftex
6580@kindex ::
6581@end iftex
6582
6583There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6584(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6585similar syntax:
6586
6587@example
6588
6589@var{module} . @var{id}
6590@var{scope} :: @var{id}
6591@end example
6592
6593@noindent
6594where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6595@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6596identifier within your program, except another module.
6597
6598Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6599specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6600found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6601enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6602
6603Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6604the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6605definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6606an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6607module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6608@var{module}.
6609
53a5351d 6610@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
6611@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6612
6613Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6614Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6615specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6616@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6617apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6618analogue in Modula-2.
6619
6620The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 6621with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c
SS
6622intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6623created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6624address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 6625@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
6626
6627@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6628In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6629interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 6630
53a5351d 6631@node Chill
cce74817
JM
6632@subsection Chill
6633
6634The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 6635from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
6636supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6637likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6638table.
6639
d4f3574e
SS
6640@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6641@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6642This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
6643of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6644
6645@menu
104c1213
JM
6646* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6647* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 6648* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
53a5351d
JM
6649* Chill type and range checks::
6650* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
6651@end menu
6652
6653@node How modes are displayed
6654@subsubsection How modes are displayed
6655
6656The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 6657with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
6658slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
6659provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
6660
6661@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
6662@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
6663@table @code
6664@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
6665@itemize @bullet
6666@item
6667@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
6668UINT, LONG, ULONG},
6669@item
6670@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
6671@item
6672@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
6673@item
6674@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
6675@smallexample
6676(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6677type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6678@end smallexample
6679If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
6680@item
6681@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by @code{type = <basemode>
6682(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}, where @code{<lower bound>, <upper
6683bound>} can be of any discrete literal expression (e.g. set element
6684names).
6685@end itemize
6686
6687@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
6688A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 6689the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
6690@smallexample
6691(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6692type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
6693@end smallexample
6694
6695@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
6696@itemize @bullet
6697@item
d4f3574e 6698@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
6699followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
6700@item
6701@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
6702@end itemize
6703
6704@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
6705The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
6706<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
6707list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
6708the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
6709all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
6710
6711@ignore
6712@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
6713The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
6714type, and is therefore not really of interest.
6715@end ignore
6716
6717@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
6718@itemize @bullet
6719@item
6720@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by @code{EVENT (<event length>)},
6721where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
6722@item
6723@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)
6724<buffer element mode>}, where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
6725@end itemize
6726
6727@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
6728@itemize @bullet
6729@item
6730@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
6731@item
6732@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
6733@end itemize
6734
6735@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
6736Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
6737
6738@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
6739@itemize @bullet
6740@item
6741@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by @code{CHARS(<string
6742length>)}, followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is
6743a varying mode
6744@item
6745@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by @code{BOOLS(<string
6746length>)}.
6747@end itemize
6748
6749@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
6750The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
6751followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
6752@smallexample
6753(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
6754type = ARRAY (1:42)
6755 ARRAY (1:20)
6756 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
6757@end smallexample
6758
6759@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
6760The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
6761list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
6762of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
6763OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
6764of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
6765checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
6766always displays all variant fields.
6767@smallexample
6768(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
6769type = STRUCT (
6770 as x,
6771 bs x,
6772 CASE bs OF
6773 (karli):
6774 cs a
6775 (ott):
6776 ds x
6777 ESAC
6778)
6779@end smallexample
6780@end table
6781
6782@node Locations
6783@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
6784
6785A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
6786
6787A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
6788the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
6789Chill programs. How values are specified
6790is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6791
6792The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
6793display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 6794
cce74817
JM
6795@smallexample
6796set result := EXPR
6797@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
6798
6799@noindent
6800This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 6801is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
6802
6803Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
6804value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 6805mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
6806represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
6807value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 6808operator @samp{->}.
cce74817
JM
6809
6810Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by @code{@{ PROC
6811(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
d4f3574e 6812location>}. @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the
cce74817
JM
6813parameter specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the
6814address of the entry point.
6815
6816@ignore
6817Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
6818fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
6819the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
6820implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
6821na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
6822<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
6823@code{__proc_copy}.
6824
6825Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
6826the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
6827like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
6828mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
6829
6830Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 6831...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 6832definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
6833of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
6834structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
6835braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 6836on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 6837memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 6838all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 6839@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
6840stuff ???)
6841@smallexample
6842(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
6843[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
6844@end smallexample
6845@end ignore
6846
6847Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
6848(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
6849certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
6850and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
6851
6852A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
6853location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
6854name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
6855have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
6856checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 6857therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 6858
cce74817
JM
6859@smallexample
6860(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
6861@end smallexample
6862
6863@node Values and their Operations
6864@subsubsection Values and their Operations
6865
6866Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
6867more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
6868data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
6869such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 6870constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 6871when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
6872(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
6873the values behind these locations.
6874
d4f3574e 6875This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
6876operations are legal to be used with such values.
6877
6878@table @code
6879@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
6880Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
6881For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 6882chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
6883@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
6884@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817
JM
6885
6886@ignore
6887@itemize @bullet
6888@item
6889@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 6890programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
6891@item
6892@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
6893@item
6894@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
6895@code{'M'})
6896@item
6897@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e
SS
6898mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
6899comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
cce74817 6900@item
d4f3574e 6901@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817
JM
6902emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
6903procedure value or the empty instance value.
6904
6905@item
6906@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 6907enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
6908to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
6909@item
6910@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
6911programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
6912@item
6913@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 6914(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
6915@end itemize
6916@end ignore
6917
6918@item Tuple Values
6919A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 6920name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
6921unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
6922@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 6923
cce74817
JM
6924@itemize @bullet
6925@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
6926@item @emph{Array Tuple}
6927@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
6928Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 6929same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
6930@end itemize
6931
6932@item String Element Value
6933A string element value is specified by @code{<string value>(<index>)},
d4f3574e 6934where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
6935value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
6936the string.
6937
6938@item String Slice Value
6939A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
6940spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
6941expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
6942@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
6943The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
6944string.
6945
6946@item Array Element Values
6947An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
6948delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
6949
6950@item Array Slice Values
6951An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
6952@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
6953@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
6954arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
6955which is part of the specified array.
6956
6957@item Structure Field Values
6958A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
6959name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
6960in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
6961corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
6962
6963@item Procedure Call Value
6964The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
6965procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
6966expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 6967effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 6968
d4f3574e 6969Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 6970
d4f3574e 6971Values of time mode locations are represented by @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}.
cce74817
JM
6972
6973@ignore
6974This is not implemented yet:
6975@item Built-in Value
6976@noindent
6977The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 6978
cce74817
JM
6979@table @code
6980@item @code{ADDR()}
6981@item @code{NUM()}
6982@item @code{PRED()}
6983@item @code{SUCC()}
6984@item @code{ABS()}
6985@item @code{CARD()}
6986@item @code{MAX()}
6987@item @code{MIN()}
6988@item @code{SIZE()}
6989@item @code{UPPER()}
6990@item @code{LOWER()}
6991@item @code{LENGTH()}
6992@item @code{SIN()}
6993@item @code{COS()}
6994@item @code{TAN()}
6995@item @code{ARCSIN()}
6996@item @code{ARCCOS()}
6997@item @code{ARCTAN()}
6998@item @code{EXP()}
6999@item @code{LN()}
7000@item @code{LOG()}
7001@item @code{SQRT()}
7002@end table
7003
7004For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7005chapter 1.6.
7006@end ignore
7007
7008@item Zero-adic Operator Value
7009The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7010current active process.
7011
7012@item Expression Values
7013The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 7014the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 7015incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 7016corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 7017causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 7018which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 7019operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 7020
cce74817
JM
7021@table @code
7022@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7023@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7024@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7025Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 7026
cce74817
JM
7027@item @code{=, /=}
7028Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 7029
cce74817 7030@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7031@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7032Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7033
cce74817 7034@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 7035@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 7036Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 7037
cce74817
JM
7038@item @code{-}
7039Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 7040
cce74817
JM
7041@item @code{//}
7042String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 7043
cce74817
JM
7044@item @code{()}
7045String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 7046
cce74817
JM
7047@item @code{->}
7048Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7049address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7050location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 7051
cce74817 7052@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
7053@itemx @code{AND}
7054@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 7055Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 7056
cce74817 7057@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 7058@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 7059Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 7060
cce74817
JM
7061@item @code{IN}
7062Membership operator.
7063@end table
7064@end table
7065
53a5351d 7066@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
7067@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7068
7069@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 7070of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 7071complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 7072equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
7073structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7074
7075Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7076index bounds and all built in procedures.
7077
7078Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 7079check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
7080operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7081functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7082language specification.
7083
cce74817
JM
7084All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7085off}.
7086
7087@ignore
53a5351d 7088@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
7089see last paragraph ?
7090@end ignore
7091
53a5351d 7092@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
7093@subsubsection Chill defaults
7094
7095If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7096both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7097Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
7098selected the working language.
7099
7100If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7101code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 7102working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
7103the language automatically}, for further details.
7104
53a5351d 7105@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
7106@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7107
d4f3574e 7108The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
7109symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7110program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7111does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7112program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7113(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7114file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7115
7116@cindex symbol names
7117@cindex names of symbols
7118@cindex quoting names
7119Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7120characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7121most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7122source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7123are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7124ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7125@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7126@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7127
7128@example
7129p 'foo.c'::x
7130@end example
7131
7132@noindent
7133looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7134
7135@table @code
7136@kindex info address
7137@item info address @var{symbol}
7138Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7139variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7140local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7141is always stored.
7142
7143Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7144at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7145the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7146
7147@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
7148@item whatis @var{expr}
7149Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
7150actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7151assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7152@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7153
7154@item whatis
7155Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7156
7157@kindex ptype
7158@item ptype @var{typename}
7159Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
7160the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7161@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7162@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 7163
d4f3574e 7164@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 7165@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 7166Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
7167differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7168of just the name of the type.
7169
7170For example, for this variable declaration:
7171
7172@example
7173struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7174@end example
7175
7176@noindent
7177the two commands give this output:
7178
7179@example
7180@group
7181(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7182type = struct complex
7183(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7184type = struct complex @{
7185 double real;
7186 double imag;
7187@}
7188@end group
7189@end example
7190
7191@noindent
7192As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7193the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7194
7195@kindex info types
7196@item info types @var{regexp}
7197@itemx info types
d4f3574e 7198Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
7199(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7200complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7201@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 7202names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
7203information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7204
7205This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7206@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7207lists all source files where a type is defined.
7208
7209@kindex info source
7210@item info source
7211Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7212the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7213it was written in.
7214
7215@kindex info sources
7216@item info sources
7217Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7218debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7219have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7220
7221@kindex info functions
7222@item info functions
7223Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7224
7225@item info functions @var{regexp}
7226Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7227whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7228Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7229include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7230start with @code{step}.
7231
7232@kindex info variables
7233@item info variables
7234Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7235outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7236
7237@item info variables @var{regexp}
7238Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7239variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7240@var{regexp}.
7241
7242@ignore
7243This was never implemented.
7244@kindex info methods
7245@item info methods
7246@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7247The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7248methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7249specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7250C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7251from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7252@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7253which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7254@end ignore
7255
c906108c
SS
7256@cindex reloading symbols
7257Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
7258be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7259in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7260running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7261@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
7262
7263@table @code
7264@kindex set symbol-reloading
7265@item set symbol-reloading on
7266Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7267object file with a particular name is seen again.
7268
7269@item set symbol-reloading off
7270Do not replace symbol definitions when re-encountering object files of
7271the same name. This is the default state; if you are not running on a
7272system that permits automatically relinking modules, you should leave
7273@code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN} may discard symbols
7274when linking large programs, that may contain several modules (from
7275different directories or libraries) with the same name.
7276
7277@kindex show symbol-reloading
7278@item show symbol-reloading
7279Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7280@end table
c906108c 7281
c906108c
SS
7282@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7283@item set opaque-type-resolution on
7284Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7285declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7286@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7287source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7288another source file. The default is on.
7289
7290A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7291the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7292
7293@item set opaque-type-resolution off
7294Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7295is printed as follows:
7296@smallexample
7297@{<no data fields>@}
7298@end smallexample
7299
7300@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7301@item show opaque-type-resolution
7302Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
7303
7304@kindex maint print symbols
7305@cindex symbol dump
7306@kindex maint print psymbols
7307@cindex partial symbol dump
7308@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7309@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7310@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7311Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7312These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7313symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7314symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7315collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7316only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7317command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7318use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7319symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7320files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7321@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7322required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7323@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7324@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7325@end table
7326
53a5351d 7327@node Altering
c906108c
SS
7328@chapter Altering Execution
7329
7330Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7331find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7332correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7333experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7334program.
7335
7336For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
7337locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7338address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
7339
7340@menu
7341* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7342* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 7343* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
7344* Returning:: Returning from a function
7345* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7346* Patching:: Patching your program
7347@end menu
7348
53a5351d 7349@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
7350@section Assignment to variables
7351
7352@cindex assignment
7353@cindex setting variables
7354To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7355@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7356
7357@example
7358print x=4
7359@end example
7360
7361@noindent
7362stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7363value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
7364@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7365information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
7366
7367@kindex set variable
7368@cindex variables, setting
7369If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7370@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7371really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7372not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7373,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7374
c906108c
SS
7375If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7376appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7377variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7378to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7379program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7380a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7381command @code{set width}:
7382
7383@example
7384(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7385type = double
7386(@value{GDBP}) p width
7387$4 = 13
7388(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7389Invalid syntax in expression.
7390@end example
7391
7392@noindent
7393The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7394order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7395
7396@example
7397(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7398@end example
53a5351d 7399
c906108c
SS
7400Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7401with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7402@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7403your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7404to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7405the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7406
7407@example
7408@group
7409(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7410type = double
7411(@value{GDBP}) p g
7412$1 = 1
7413(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 7414(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
7415$2 = 1
7416(@value{GDBP}) r
7417The program being debugged has been started already.
7418Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7419Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7420"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: Invalid bfd target.
7421(@value{GDBP}) show g
7422The current BFD target is "=4".
7423@end group
7424@end example
7425
7426@noindent
7427The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7428@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7429@code{g}, use
7430
7431@example
7432(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7433@end example
c906108c
SS
7434
7435@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7436freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7437and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7438same length or shorter.
7439@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7440@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7441
7442To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7443construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7444(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7445to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7446and representation in memory), and
7447
7448@example
7449set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7450@end example
7451
7452@noindent
7453stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7454
53a5351d 7455@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
7456@section Continuing at a different address
7457
7458Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7459it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7460an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7461
7462@table @code
7463@kindex jump
7464@item jump @var{linespec}
7465Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7466immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7467source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7468@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7469in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7470breakpoints}.
7471
7472The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7473the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7474register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7475a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7476be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7477of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7478confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7479executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7480well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7481
7482@item jump *@var{address}
7483Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7484@end table
7485
c906108c 7486@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
7487On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7488command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7489difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7490changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7491example,
c906108c
SS
7492
7493@example
7494set $pc = 0x485
7495@end example
7496
7497@noindent
7498makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7499address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7500@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
7501
7502The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7503up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7504that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7505detail.
7506
c906108c 7507@c @group
53a5351d 7508@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
7509@section Giving your program a signal
7510
7511@table @code
7512@kindex signal
7513@item signal @var{signal}
7514Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7515signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7516signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7517SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7518
7519Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7520giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7521a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7522@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7523signal.
7524
7525@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7526after executing the command.
7527@end table
7528@c @end group
7529
7530Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7531@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7532causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7533the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7534passes the signal directly to your program.
7535
c906108c 7536
53a5351d 7537@node Returning
c906108c
SS
7538@section Returning from a function
7539
7540@table @code
7541@cindex returning from a function
7542@kindex return
7543@item return
7544@itemx return @var{expression}
7545You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7546command. If you give an
7547@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7548value.
7549@end table
7550
7551When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7552(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7553discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7554be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7555
7556This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7557frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7558innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7559specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7560of functions.
7561
7562The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7563program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7564returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7565and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7566selected stack frame returns naturally.
7567
53a5351d 7568@node Calling
c906108c
SS
7569@section Calling program functions
7570
7571@cindex calling functions
7572@kindex call
7573@table @code
7574@item call @var{expr}
7575Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7576returned values.
7577@end table
7578
7579You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7580execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7581with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7582is printed and saved in the value history.
7583
c906108c
SS
7584For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7585specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7586calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7587method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7588that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 7589
53a5351d 7590@node Patching
c906108c 7591@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 7592
c906108c
SS
7593@cindex patching binaries
7594@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 7595@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 7596
7a292a7a
SS
7597By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7598executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7599alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7600patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
7601
7602If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7603explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7604want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7605repairs.
7606
7607@table @code
7608@kindex set write
7609@item set write on
7610@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
7611If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7612core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
7613off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7614
7615If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
7616@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7617write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
7618
7619@item show write
7620@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
7621Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
7622as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
7623@end table
7624
53a5351d 7625@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
7626@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
7627
7a292a7a
SS
7628@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
7629both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
7630program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
7631@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
7632
7633@menu
7634* Files:: Commands to specify files
7635* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
7636@end menu
7637
53a5351d 7638@node Files
c906108c 7639@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 7640
7a292a7a 7641@cindex symbol table
c906108c 7642@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
7643
7644You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
7645way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
7646@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
7647Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
7648
7649Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
7650@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
7651a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
7652to specify new files are useful.
7653
7654@table @code
7655@cindex executable file
7656@kindex file
7657@item file @var{filename}
7658Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
7659symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
7660executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
7661directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
7662@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
7663directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
7664to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
7665and your program, using the @code{path} command.
7666
c906108c
SS
7667On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file
7668@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
7669@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
7670@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
7671descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
7672(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
7673@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
7674for more information.
c906108c
SS
7675
7676@item file
7677@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
7678has on both executable file and the symbol table.
7679
7680@kindex exec-file
7681@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7682Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
7683in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
7684if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
7685discard information on the executable file.
7686
7687@kindex symbol-file
7688@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7689Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
7690searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
7691table and program to run from the same file.
7692
7693@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
7694program's symbol table.
7695
7696The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
7697of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
7698auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
7699the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
7700the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
7701
7702@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
7703executing it once.
7704
7705When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
7706understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
7707generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
7708other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
7709Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
7710using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
7711optimized code.
c906108c
SS
7712
7713For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
7714using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
7715symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
7716quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
7717details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
7718
7719The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
7720start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
7721occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
7722file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
7723pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
7724warnings and messages}.)
7725
c906108c
SS
7726We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
7727symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
7728symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
7729still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
7730in stabs format.
7731
7732@kindex readnow
7733@cindex reading symbols immediately
7734@cindex symbols, reading immediately
7735@kindex mapped
7736@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
7737@cindex saving symbol table
7738@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7739@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
7740You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
7741tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
7742load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
7743entire symbol table available.
c906108c 7744
c906108c
SS
7745If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
7746@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
7747cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
7748file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
7749from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
7750than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
7751program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
7752starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
7753
7754You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
7755file has all the symbol information for your program.
7756
7757The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
7758@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
7759than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
7760it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
7761needed.
7762
7763The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
7764@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
7765symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
7766
7767@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
7768@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
7769@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
7770@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
7771@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
7772@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
7773@c files.
7774
7775@kindex core
7776@kindex core-file
7777@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
7778Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
7779of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
7780address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
7781executable file itself for other parts.
7782
7783@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
7784to be used.
7785
7786Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
7787under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
7788wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
7789the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 7790(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 7791
c906108c
SS
7792@kindex add-symbol-file
7793@cindex dynamic linking
7794@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
7795@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
2acceee2
JM
7796@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @var{data_address} @var{bss_address}
7797@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
c906108c
SS
7798The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table information
7799from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command when @var{filename}
7800has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) into the program that
7801is running. @var{address} should be the memory address at which the
7802file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure this out for itself.
2acceee2
JM
7803You can specify up to three addresses, in which case they are taken to be
7804the addresses of the text, data, and bss segments respectively.
7805For complicated cases, you can specify an arbitrary number of @r{-T}@var{section} @var{address}
7806pairs, to give an explicit section name and base address for that section.
7807You can specify any @var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
7808
7809The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
7810originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
7811@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data thus
7812read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data instead,
7813use the @code{symbol-file} command.
7814
7815@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7816
7817You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
7818the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
7819table information for @var{filename}.
7820
7821@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
7822@item add-shared-symbol-file
7823The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
7824operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
7825shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
7826@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 7827
c906108c
SS
7828@kindex section
7829@item section
7830The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
7831the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
7832section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
7833specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
7834separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
7835the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
7836
7837@kindex info files
7838@kindex info target
7839@item info files
7840@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
7841@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
7842current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
7843including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
7844use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
7845command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
7846current ones.
7847
c906108c
SS
7848@end table
7849
7850All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
7851as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
7852name and remembers it that way.
7853
c906108c 7854@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
7855@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
7856libraries.
53a5351d 7857
c906108c
SS
7858@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
7859when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
7860(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
7861references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
7862debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
7863
7864On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
7865automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
7866
c906108c
SS
7867@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
7868@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
7869@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
7870
7871@table @code
7872@kindex info sharedlibrary
7873@kindex info share
7874@item info share
7875@itemx info sharedlibrary
7876Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
7877
7878@kindex sharedlibrary
7879@kindex share
7880@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
7881@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
7882Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
7883Unix regular expression.
7884As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
7885required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
7886@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
7887loaded.
7888@end table
7889
53a5351d
JM
7890On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
7891and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
7892a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
7893
7894Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
7895loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
7896@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
7897automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
7898
7899To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
7900
7901@table @code
7902@kindex set auto-solib-add
7903@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
7904Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
7905nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
7906automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
7907linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
7908the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
7909Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
7910@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
7911
7912@kindex show auto-solib-add
7913@item show auto-solib-add
7914Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
7915@end table
c906108c 7916
53a5351d 7917@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
7918@section Errors reading symbol files
7919
7920While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
7921such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
7922output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
7923they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
7924debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
7925about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
7926only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
7927times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
7928to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
7929complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7930messages}).
7931
7932The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
7933
7934@table @code
7935@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
7936
7937The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
7938(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
7939error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
7940in its outer scope blocks.
7941
7942@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
7943the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
7944may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
7945function.
7946
7947@item block at @var{address} out of order
7948
7949The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
7950order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
7951do so.
7952
7953@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
7954locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
7955can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
7956@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
7957messages}.)
7958
7959@item bad block start address patched
7960
7961The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
7962smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
7963to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
7964
7965@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
7966starting on the previous source line.
7967
7968@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
7969
7970@cindex foo
7971Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
7972larger than the size of the string table.
7973
7974@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
7975name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
7976with this name.
7977
7978@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
7979
7a292a7a
SS
7980The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
7981not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 7982uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 7983
7a292a7a
SS
7984@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
7985This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 7986are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
7987debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
7988on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
7989and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
7990
7991@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 7992
7a292a7a 7993@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 7994
7a292a7a 7995@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
c906108c 7996The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
7997information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
7998it.
c906108c
SS
7999
8000@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8001
8002@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 8003
c906108c
SS
8004@end table
8005
53a5351d 8006@node Targets
c906108c 8007@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 8008
c906108c
SS
8009@cindex debugging target
8010@kindex target
8011
8012A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
8013
8014Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8015in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8016you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
8017flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8018host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
8019realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8020command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8021(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
8022
8023@menu
8024* Active Targets:: Active targets
8025* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
8026* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8027* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 8028* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
8029
8030@end menu
8031
53a5351d 8032@node Active Targets
c906108c 8033@section Active targets
7a292a7a 8034
c906108c
SS
8035@cindex stacking targets
8036@cindex active targets
8037@cindex multiple targets
8038
c906108c 8039There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
8040executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8041active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8042start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8043a core file.
c906108c
SS
8044
8045For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8046@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8047well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8048@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8049first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8050requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8051are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8052read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8053executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
8054
8055When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
8056target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8057commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8058an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8059process target is active.
c906108c 8060
7a292a7a
SS
8061Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8062core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 8063files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
8064the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8065process}).
c906108c 8066
53a5351d 8067@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
8068@section Commands for managing targets
8069
8070@table @code
8071@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
8072Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8073process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8074facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8075protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
8076
8077Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8078typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8079with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
8080
8081The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8082after executing the command.
8083
8084@kindex help target
8085@item help target
8086Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8087currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8088(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8089
8090@item help target @var{name}
8091Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8092select it.
8093
8094@kindex set gnutarget
8095@item set gnutarget @var{args}
8096@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8097knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8098a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8099with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8100with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8101
d4f3574e 8102@quotation
c906108c
SS
8103@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8104you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 8105@end quotation
c906108c 8106
d4f3574e
SS
8107@noindent
8108@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c
SS
8109
8110@kindex show gnutarget
8111@item show gnutarget
8112Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8113@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8114@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8115and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8116@end table
8117
c906108c
SS
8118Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8119configuration):
c906108c
SS
8120
8121@table @code
8122@kindex target exec
8123@item target exec @var{program}
8124An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8125@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8126
c906108c
SS
8127@kindex target core
8128@item target core @var{filename}
8129A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8130@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
8131
8132@kindex target remote
8133@item target remote @var{dev}
8134Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8135specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8136@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8137supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
8138some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8139it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8140
c906108c
SS
8141@kindex target sim
8142@item target sim
2df3850c 8143Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
8144In general,
8145@example
8146 target sim
8147 load
8148 run
8149@end example
d4f3574e 8150@noindent
104c1213 8151works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 8152drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
8153provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8154see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8155Processors}.
8156
c906108c
SS
8157@end table
8158
104c1213 8159Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
8160
8161@table @code
8162
c906108c
SS
8163@kindex target nrom
8164@item target nrom @var{dev}
8165NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8166
c906108c
SS
8167@end table
8168
c906108c
SS
8169Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8170your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
8171
8172Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8173once you've successfully established a connection.
8174
8175@table @code
8176
8177@kindex load @var{filename}
8178@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
8179Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8180@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8181is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8182on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8183@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8184the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8185
8186If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8187execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8188target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
8189
8190The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8191For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8192link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8193specifies a fixed address.
8194@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8195
c906108c
SS
8196@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8197@end table
8198
53a5351d 8199@node Byte Order
c906108c 8200@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 8201
c906108c
SS
8202@cindex choosing target byte order
8203@cindex target byte order
8204@kindex set endian big
8205@kindex set endian little
8206@kindex set endian auto
8207@kindex show endian
8208
8209Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8210offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8211orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8212designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8213which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 8214@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
8215
8216@table @code
8217@kindex set endian big
8218@item set endian big
8219Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8220
8221@kindex set endian little
8222@item set endian little
8223Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8224
8225@kindex set endian auto
8226@item set endian auto
8227Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8228executable.
8229
8230@item show endian
8231Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8232
8233@end table
8234
8235Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8236data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8237target system.
8238
53a5351d 8239@node Remote
c906108c
SS
8240@section Remote debugging
8241@cindex remote debugging
8242
8243If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8244@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8245For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8246or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8247powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8248
8249Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8250to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8251@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8252but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8253write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8254communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8255
8256Other remote targets may be available in your
8257configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 8258
c906108c 8259@menu
c906108c 8260* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
8261@end menu
8262
104c1213
JM
8263@node Remote Serial
8264@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 8265
104c1213
JM
8266@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8267To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8268@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8269prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8270program, you need:
c906108c 8271
104c1213
JM
8272@enumerate
8273@item
8274A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8275have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8276your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 8277
104c1213 8278@item
d4f3574e 8279A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 8280subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 8281
104c1213
JM
8282@item
8283A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8284download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8285manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8286documentation.
8287@end enumerate
96baa820 8288
104c1213
JM
8289The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8290communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8291machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 8292
104c1213
JM
8293@table @emph
8294@item On the host,
8295@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8296else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8297(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8298
8299@item On the target,
8300you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8301implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8302subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8303
8304On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8305@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8306@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8307@end table
96baa820 8308
104c1213
JM
8309The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8310machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8311@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 8312
104c1213
JM
8313@cindex remote serial stub list
8314These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 8315
104c1213
JM
8316@table @code
8317
8318@item i386-stub.c
8319@kindex i386-stub.c
8320@cindex Intel
8321@cindex i386
8322For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8323
8324@item m68k-stub.c
8325@kindex m68k-stub.c
8326@cindex Motorola 680x0
8327@cindex m680x0
8328For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8329
8330@item sh-stub.c
8331@kindex sh-stub.c
8332@cindex Hitachi
8333@cindex SH
8334For Hitachi SH architectures.
8335
8336@item sparc-stub.c
8337@kindex sparc-stub.c
8338@cindex Sparc
8339For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8340
8341@item sparcl-stub.c
8342@kindex sparcl-stub.c
8343@cindex Fujitsu
8344@cindex SparcLite
8345For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8346
8347@end table
8348
8349The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8350recently added stubs.
8351
8352@menu
8353* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8354* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8355* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8356* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8357* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8358* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8359@end menu
8360
8361@node Stub Contents
8362@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8363
8364@cindex remote serial stub
8365The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8366subroutines:
8367
8368@table @code
8369@item set_debug_traps
8370@kindex set_debug_traps
8371@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8372This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8373program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8374beginning of your program.
8375
8376@item handle_exception
8377@kindex handle_exception
8378@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8379This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8380explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8381run when a trap is triggered.
8382
8383@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8384execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8385with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8386protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 8387representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
8388information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8389retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8390execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8391@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8392machine.
8393
8394@item breakpoint
8395@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8396Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8397breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8398way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8399machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8400pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8401@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8402simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8403again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8404your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8405@value{GDBN} session gets control.
8406
8407Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8408to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8409start of your debugging session.
8410@end table
8411
8412@node Bootstrapping
8413@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8414
8415@cindex remote stub, support routines
8416The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8417chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8418debugging target machine.
8419
8420First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8421serial port.
8422
8423@table @code
8424@item int getDebugChar()
8425@kindex getDebugChar
8426Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8427It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8428different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8429
8430@item void putDebugChar(int)
8431@kindex putDebugChar
8432Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8433It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8434different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8435@end table
8436
8437@cindex control C, and remote debugging
8438@cindex interrupting remote targets
8439If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8440running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8441for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8442character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8443remote system to stop.
8444
8445Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8446probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8447is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8448@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8449
8450Other routines you need to supply are:
8451
8452@table @code
8453@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8454@kindex exceptionHandler
8455Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8456handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8457way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8458are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8459containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8460@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8461its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8462might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8463exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8464@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8465and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8466you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8467should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8468
8469For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8470gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8471should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8472@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8473help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8474
8475@item void flush_i_cache()
8476@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 8477On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
8478instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8479instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8480
8481On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8482function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8483@end table
8484
8485@noindent
8486You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8487
8488@table @code
8489@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8490@kindex memset
8491This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8492memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8493@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8494either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8495@end table
8496
8497If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8498library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8499but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 8500subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
8501
8502
8503@node Debug Session
8504@subsubsection Putting it all together
8505
8506@cindex remote serial debugging summary
8507In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8508steps.
8509
8510@enumerate
8511@item
8512Make sure you have the supporting low-level routines
8513(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8514@display
8515@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8516@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8517@end display
8518
8519@item
8520Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8521
8522@example
8523set_debug_traps();
8524breakpoint();
8525@end example
8526
8527@item
8528For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8529@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8530
8531@example
8532void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8533@end example
8534
d4f3574e 8535@noindent
104c1213 8536but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
d4f3574e 8537function in your program; that function is called when
104c1213
JM
8538@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8539error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8540one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8541
8542@item
8543Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8544your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8545
8546@item
8547Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8548the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8549
8550@item
8551@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8552@c document that. FIXME.
8553Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8554whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8555
8556@item
8557To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8558as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8559This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8560of its pure text.
8561
d4f3574e 8562@item
104c1213 8563@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 8564Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
8565Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8566machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8567TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8568to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8569device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8570
8571@example
8572target remote /dev/ttyb
8573@end example
8574
8575@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8576To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8577@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8578terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8579
8580@example
8581target remote manyfarms:2828
8582@end example
8583@end enumerate
8584
8585Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8586step and continue the remote program.
8587
8588To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8589command.
8590
8591@cindex interrupting remote programs
8592@cindex remote programs, interrupting
8593Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8594interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8595program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8596and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8597interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8598
8599@example
8600Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8601Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8602@end example
8603
8604If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8605(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8606remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8607goes back to waiting.
8608
8609@node Protocol
8610@subsubsection Communication protocol
8611
8612@cindex debugging stub, example
8613@cindex remote stub, example
8614@cindex stub example, remote debugging
8615The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8616communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8617@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8618these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8619implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8620with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8621organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8622
8623However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8624the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8625target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8626it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
8627
8628In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
8629transmitted and received data respectfully.
8630
8631@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
8632@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
8633@cindex remote serial protocol
8634All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments)
8635are sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the
8636character @samp{$}, this is followed by an optional two-digit
8637@var{sequence-id} and the character @samp{:}, the actual
8638@var{packet-data}, and the terminating character @samp{#} followed by a
8639two-digit @var{checksum}:
8640
8641@example
8642@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8643@end example
8644@noindent
8645or, with the optional @var{sequence-id}:
8646@example
8647@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8648@end example
8649
8650@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
8651@noindent
8652The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
8653characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (that
8654consisting of both the optional @var{sequence-id}@code{:} and the actual
d4f3574e 8655@var{packet-data}) (an eight bit unsigned checksum).
104c1213
JM
8656
8657@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
8658@noindent
8659The two-digit @var{sequence-id}, when present, is returned with the
8660acknowledgment. Beyond that its meaning is poorly defined.
8661@value{GDBN} is not known to output @var{sequence-id}s.
8662
8663When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
8664response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
8665the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
8666retransmission):
8667
8668@example
8669<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8670-> @code{+}
8671@end example
8672@noindent
8673If the received packet included a @var{sequence-id} than that is
8674appended to a positive acknowledgment:
8675
8676@example
8677<- @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
8678-> @code{+}@var{sequence-id}
8679@end example
8680
8681The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
8682debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
8683the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
8684when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
8685
8686@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
8687exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for an
8688exception). @samp{:} can not appear as the third character in a packet.
8689Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} and @samp{;}
8690(unfortunately some packets chose to use @samp{:}). Except where
8691otherwise noted all numbers are represented in HEX with leading zeros
8692suppressed.
8693
8694Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 8695means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
8696which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
8697@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
8698where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
8699characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
8700value greater than 126 should not be used.
8701
8702Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
8703loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
8704character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
8705
8706So:
8707@example
8708"@code{0* }"
8709@end example
8710@noindent
8711means the same as "0000".
8712
8713The error response, returned for some packets includes a two character
8714error number. That number is not well defined.
8715
8716For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
8717(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
8718protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 8719on that response.
104c1213
JM
8720
8721Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
8722their corresponding response @var{data}:
8723
8724@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
8725@item Packet
8726@tab Request
8727@tab Description
8728
8729@item extended ops @emph{(optional)}
8730@tab @code{!}
8731@tab
d4f3574e 8732Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
104c1213
JM
8733The extended remote protocol support the @samp{R} packet.
8734@item
8735@tab reply @samp{}
8736@tab
8737Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
8738unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
8739support protocol extensions.
8740
8741@item last signal
8742@tab @code{?}
8743@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8744Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
8745and continue.
8746@item
8747@tab reply
8748@tab see below
8749
104c1213
JM
8750
8751@item reserved
8752@tab @code{a}
8753@tab Reserved for future use
8754
8755@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8756@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
8757@tab
8758Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
8759specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 8760See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
8761@item
8762@tab reply @code{OK}
8763@item
8764@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8765
8766@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
8767@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
8768@tab
8769Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
8770transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
8771transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
8772acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
8773to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
8774ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
8775specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
8776that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
8777happened.}
8778
8779@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
8780@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
8781@tab
8782Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
8783breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
8784@samp{z} packets.}
8785
8786@item continue
8787@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
8788@tab
8789@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8790current address.
8791@item
8792@tab reply
8793@tab see below
8794
8795@item continue with signal @emph{(optional)}
8796@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
8797@tab
8798Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
8799@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
8800@item
8801@tab reply
8802@tab see below
8803
d4f3574e 8804@item toggle debug @emph{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
8805@tab @code{d}
8806@tab
d4f3574e 8807toggle debug flag.
104c1213
JM
8808
8809@item detach @emph{(optional)}
8810@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 8811@tab
2df3850c
JM
8812Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
8813@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
8814@item
8815@tab reply @emph{no response}
8816@tab
2df3850c 8817@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet
104c1213
JM
8818
8819@item reserved
8820@tab @code{e}
8821@tab Reserved for future use
8822
8823@item reserved
8824@tab @code{E}
8825@tab Reserved for future use
8826
8827@item reserved
8828@tab @code{f}
8829@tab Reserved for future use
8830
8831@item reserved
8832@tab @code{F}
8833@tab Reserved for future use
8834
8835@item read registers
8836@tab @code{g}
8837@tab Read general registers.
8838@item
8839@tab reply @var{XX...}
8840@tab
8841Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
8842with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 8843each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 8844determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
8845@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8846@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
8847@item
8848@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
8849@tab for an error.
8850
8851@item write regs
8852@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
8853@tab
8854See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
8855@item
8856@tab reply @code{OK}
8857@tab for success
8858@item
8859@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8860@tab for an error
8861
8862@item reserved
8863@tab @code{h}
8864@tab Reserved for future use
8865
8866@item set thread @emph{(optional)}
8867@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
8868@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8869Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
8870@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
8871continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
8872thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
8873@item
8874@tab reply @code{OK}
8875@tab for success
8876@item
8877@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8878@tab for an error
8879
d4f3574e
SS
8880@c FIXME: JTC:
8881@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
8882@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
8883@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
8884@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
8885@c described. For example:
8886@c
8887@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8888@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
8889@c otherwise returns current registers.
8890@c
8891@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
8892@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
8893@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
8894
104c1213
JM
8895@item cycle step @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
8896@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
8897@tab
8898Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
8899present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
8900step starting at that address.
8901
8902@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)} @emph{(optional)}
8903@tab @code{I}
8904@tab
8905See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
8906
8907@item reserved
8908@tab @code{j}
8909@tab Reserved for future use
8910
8911@item reserved
8912@tab @code{J}
8913@tab Reserved for future use
8914
8915@item kill request @emph{(optional)}
8916@tab @code{k}
8917@tab
d4f3574e
SS
8918FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
8919thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
8920
8921@item reserved
8922@tab @code{l}
8923@tab Reserved for future use
8924
8925@item reserved
8926@tab @code{L}
8927@tab Reserved for future use
8928
8929@item read memory
8930@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
8931@tab
8932Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 8933Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
8934using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8935transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8936@item
8937@tab reply @var{XX...}
8938@tab
d4f3574e 8939@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 8940to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
8941sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
8942@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
8943@item
8944@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8945@tab @var{NN} is errno
8946
8947@item write mem
8948@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
8949@tab
8950Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
8951@var{XX...} is the data.
8952@item
8953@tab reply @code{OK}
8954@tab for success
8955@item
8956@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8957@tab
8958for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
8959written).
8960
8961@item reserved
8962@tab @code{n}
8963@tab Reserved for future use
8964
8965@item reserved
8966@tab @code{N}
8967@tab Reserved for future use
8968
8969@item reserved
8970@tab @code{o}
8971@tab Reserved for future use
8972
8973@item reserved
8974@tab @code{O}
8975@tab Reserved for future use
8976
8977@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
8978@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
8979@tab
8980See write register.
8981@item
8982@tab return @var{r....}
8983@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
8984
8985@item write reg @emph{(optional)}
8986@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
8987@tab
8988Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
8989digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
8990@item
8991@tab reply @code{OK}
8992@tab for success
8993@item
8994@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
8995@tab for an error
8996
8997@item general query @emph{(optional)}
8998@tab @code{q}@var{query}
8999@tab
d4f3574e 9000Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} @var{query}'s
104c1213 9001have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
9002company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9003optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9004must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
9005@item
9006@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 9007@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
9008@item
9009@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9010@tab error reply
9011@item
9012@tab reply @samp{}
9013@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9014
104c1213
JM
9015@item general set @emph{(optional)}
9016@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9017@tab
9018Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9019naming conventions.
9020
d4f3574e
SS
9021@item reset @emph{(deprecated)}
9022@tab @code{r}
9023@tab
9024Reset the entire system.
104c1213
JM
9025
9026@item remote restart @emph{(optional)}
9027@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9028@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9029Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9030definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9031packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213
JM
9032
9033@item step @emph{(optional)}
9034@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9035@tab
9036@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9037same address.
9038@item
9039@tab reply
9040@tab see below
9041
9042@item step with signal @emph{(optional)}
9043@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9044@tab
9045Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9046@item
9047@tab reply
9048@tab see below
9049
9050@item search @emph{(optional)}
9051@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9052@tab
9053Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9054@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 9055bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213
JM
9056
9057@item thread alive @emph{(optional)}
9058@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9059@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9060@item
9061@tab reply @code{OK}
9062@tab thread is still alive
9063@item
9064@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9065@tab thread is dead
9066
9067@item reserved
9068@tab @code{u}
9069@tab Reserved for future use
9070
9071@item reserved
9072@tab @code{U}
9073@tab Reserved for future use
9074
9075@item reserved
9076@tab @code{v}
9077@tab Reserved for future use
9078
9079@item reserved
9080@tab @code{V}
9081@tab Reserved for future use
9082
9083@item reserved
9084@tab @code{w}
9085@tab Reserved for future use
9086
9087@item reserved
9088@tab @code{W}
9089@tab Reserved for future use
9090
9091@item reserved
9092@tab @code{x}
9093@tab Reserved for future use
9094
9095@item write mem (binary) @emph{(optional)}
9096@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9097@tab
9098@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
9099binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9100escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
9101@item
9102@tab reply @code{OK}
9103@tab for success
9104@item
9105@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9106@tab for an error
9107
9108@item reserved
9109@tab @code{y}
9110@tab Reserved for future use
9111
9112@item reserved
9113@tab @code{Y}
9114@tab Reserved for future use
9115
9116@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9117@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9118@tab
9119See @samp{Z}.
9120
9121@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)} @emph{(optional)}
9122@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9123@tab
9124@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9125breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9126@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9127bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9128the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
9129@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9130potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9131implemented in an ident-potentent way.
104c1213
JM
9132@item
9133@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9134@tab for an error
9135@item
9136@tab reply @code{OK}
9137@tab for success
9138@item
9139@tab @samp{}
9140@tab If not supported.
9141
9142@item reserved
9143@tab <other>
9144@tab Reserved for future use
9145
9146@end multitable
9147
d4f3574e
SS
9148The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9149receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9150@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9151when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9152number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9153conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
9154
9155@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9156
9157@item @code{S}@var{AA}
9158@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9159
9160@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9161@tab
9162@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9163(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9164by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9165thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 9166starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
9167@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9168extend the protocol.
9169
9170@item @code{W}@var{AA}
9171@tab
9172The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9173applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9174
9175@item @code{X}@var{AA}
9176@tab
9177The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9178
9179@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{tttttttt}@code{;}@var{dddddddd}@code{;}@var{bbbbbbbb} @strong{(obsolete)}
9180@tab
9181@var{AA} = signal number; @var{tttttttt} = address of symbol "_start";
9182@var{dddddddd} = base of data section; @var{bbbbbbbb} = base of bss
d4f3574e 9183section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference
104c1213
JM
9184between this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may
9185arrive spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the
9186host debugger.}
9187
9188@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9189@tab
c3f6f71d 9190@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
9191while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9192for 'W', 'T', etc.
9193
9194@end multitable
9195
d4f3574e
SS
9196The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9197
9198@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9199
9200@item current thread
9201@tab @code{q}@code{C}
9202@tab Return the current thread id.
9203@item
9204@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9205@tab
9206Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9207@item
9208@tab reply *
9209@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9210
9211@item compute CRC of memory block
9212@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9213@tab
9214@item
9215@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9216@tab An error (such as memory fault)
9217@item
9218@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9219@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9220
9221@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9222@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9223@tab
9224Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9225digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9226subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9227number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9228(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9229returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9230@item
9231@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9232@tab
9233Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9234returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9235and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9236digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9237a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9238digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9239
9240@item query sect offs
9241@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
9242@tab
9243Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9244image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9245response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9246offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
9247@item
9248@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9249
9250@item thread info request
9251@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9252@tab
9253Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9254encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9255@item
9256@tab reply *
9257@tab
9258See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9259
9260@item remote command
9261@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9262@tab
9263@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9264execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9265Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9266number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9267packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9268stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9269@item
9270@tab reply @code{OK}
9271@tab
9272A command response with no output.
9273@item
9274@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9275@tab
9276A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9277@item
9278@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9279@tab
9280Indicate a badly formed request.
9281
9282@item
9283@tab reply @samp{}
9284@tab
9285When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9286
9287@end multitable
9288
9289The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9290In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9291bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9292space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9293The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9294least-significant.
9295
9296@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9297
9298@item MIPS32
9299@tab
9300All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
930132 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9302registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9303
9304@item MIPS64
9305@tab
9306All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9307thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9308as @code{MIPS32}.
9309
9310@end multitable
9311
104c1213
JM
9312Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9313does not get any direct output:
9314
9315@example
9316<- @code{R00}
9317-> @code{+}
9318@emph{target restarts}
9319<- @code{?}
9320-> @code{+}
9321-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9322<- @code{+}
9323@end example
9324
9325Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9326
9327@example
9328<- @code{G1445...}
9329-> @code{+}
9330<- @code{s}
9331-> @code{+}
9332@emph{time passes}
9333-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9334<- @code{+}
9335<- @code{g}
9336-> @code{+}
9337-> @code{1455...}
9338<- @code{+}
9339@end example
9340
d4f3574e
SS
9341@kindex set remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
9342@kindex show remotedebug@r{, serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
9343@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
9344@cindex serial connections, debugging
9345If you have trouble with the serial connection, you can use the command
9346@code{set remotedebug}. This makes @value{GDBN} report on all packets sent
9347back and forth across the serial line to the remote machine. The
9348packet-debugging information is printed on the @value{GDBN} standard output
9349stream. @code{set remotedebug off} turns it off, and @code{show
9350remotedebug} shows you its current state.
9351
9352@node Server
9353@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9354
9355@kindex gdbserver
9356@cindex remote connection without stubs
9357@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9358allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9359@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9360
9361@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9362because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9363that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9364@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9365@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9366because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9367also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9368started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9369Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9370the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9371do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9372by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9373choice for debugging.
9374
9375@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9376or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9377protocol.
9378
9379@table @emph
9380@item On the target machine,
9381you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9382@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9383strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9384system does all the symbol handling.
9385
9386To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9387the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9388syntax is:
9389
9390@smallexample
9391target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9392@end smallexample
9393
9394@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9395hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9396@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9397@file{/dev/com1}:
9398
9399@smallexample
9400target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9401@end smallexample
9402
9403@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9404with it.
9405
9406To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9407
9408@smallexample
9409target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9410@end smallexample
9411
9412The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9413specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9414TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9415expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9416(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9417you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9418TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9419reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9420conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 9421and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
9422@code{target remote} command.
9423
9424@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9425you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9426symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9427using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9428(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9429running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9430remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9431is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9432@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9433@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9434
9435@smallexample
9436(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9437@end smallexample
9438
9439@noindent
9440communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9441
9442@smallexample
9443(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9444@end smallexample
9445
9446@noindent
9447communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9448For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9449the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9450text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9451@samp{Connection refused}.
9452@end table
9453
9454@node NetWare
9455@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9456
9457@kindex gdbserve.nlm
9458@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9459allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9460@code{target remote}.
9461
9462@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9463using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9464
9465@table @emph
9466@item On the target machine,
9467you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9468@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9469can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9470host system does all the symbol handling.
9471
9472To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9473@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9474program. The syntax is:
9475
9476@smallexample
9477load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9478 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9479@end smallexample
9480
9481@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9482the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 9483to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
9484
9485For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9486communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 9487using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
9488
9489@smallexample
9490load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9491@end smallexample
9492
9493@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9494you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9495symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9496using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9497(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 9498running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
9499remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9500argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9501@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9502
9503@smallexample
9504(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9505@end smallexample
9506
9507@noindent
9508communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9509@end table
9510
9511@node KOD
9512@section Kernel Object Display
9513
9514@cindex kernel object display
9515@cindex kernel object
9516@cindex KOD
9517
9518Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9519@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9520and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9521mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9522displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9523
9524Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9525@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9526
9527@example
2df3850c 9528(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
9529@end example
9530
9531If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9532about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9533which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9534after the operating system:
9535
9536@example
2df3850c 9537(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
9538List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9539Object Description
9540any Any and all objects
9541@end example
9542
9543Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9544by the kernel.
9545
9546There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
9547is supported other than to try it.
9548
9549
104c1213
JM
9550@node Configurations
9551@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9552
9553While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9554cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9555describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9556
9557There are three major categories of configurations: native
9558configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9559operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9560different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9561are quite different from each other.
9562
9563@menu
9564* Native::
9565* Embedded OS::
9566* Embedded Processors::
9567* Architectures::
9568@end menu
9569
9570@node Native
9571@section Native
9572
9573This section describes details specific to particular native
9574configurations.
9575
9576@menu
9577* HP-UX:: HP-UX
9578* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
9579@end menu
9580
9581@node HP-UX
9582@subsection HP-UX
9583
9584On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
9585begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
9586name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
9587
9588@node SVR4 Process Information
9589@subsection SVR4 process information
9590
9591@kindex /proc
9592@cindex process image
9593
9594Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
9595used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
9596subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
9597this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
9598several kinds of information about the process running your program.
9599@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
9600@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
9601and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
9602
9603@table @code
9604@kindex info proc
9605@item info proc
9606Summarize available information about the process.
9607
9608@kindex info proc mappings
9609@item info proc mappings
9610Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
9611on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
9612
9613@kindex info proc times
9614@item info proc times
9615Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
9616its children.
9617
9618@kindex info proc id
9619@item info proc id
9620Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
9621the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
9622
9623@kindex info proc status
9624@item info proc status
9625General information on the state of the process. If the process is
9626stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
9627received.
9628
9629@item info proc all
9630Show all the above information about the process.
9631@end table
9632
9633@node Embedded OS
9634@section Embedded Operating Systems
9635
9636This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
9637embedded operating systems that are available for several different
9638architectures.
9639
9640@menu
9641* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9642@end menu
9643
9644@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
9645various real-time operating systems.
9646
9647@node VxWorks
9648@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
9649
9650@cindex VxWorks
9651
9652@table @code
9653
9654@kindex target vxworks
9655@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
9656A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
9657is the target system's machine name or IP address.
9658
9659@end table
9660
9661On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
9662current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
9663
9664@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
9665VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
9666the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
9667both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 9668@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 9669installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
d4f3574e 9670@value{GDB} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
9671
9672@table @code
9673@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
9674@kindex vxworks-timeout
9675All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
9676This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
9677seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
9678your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
9679of a thin network line.
9680@end table
9681
9682The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
9683this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
9684procedures.
9685
9686@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
9687To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
9688to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
9689library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
9690VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
9691kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
9692source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
9693information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
9694manual.
9695@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
9696
9697Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
9698your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 9699run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or @code{vxgdb},
104c1213
JM
9700depending on your installation).
9701
9702@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
9703
9704@example
9705(vxgdb)
9706@end example
9707
9708@menu
9709* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
9710* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
9711* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
9712@end menu
9713
9714@node VxWorks Connection
9715@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
9716
9717The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
9718network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
9719
9720@example
9721(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
9722@end example
9723
9724@need 750
9725@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
9726
9727@smallexample
9728Attaching remote machine across net...
9729Connected to tt.
9730@end smallexample
9731
9732@need 1000
9733@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
9734loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
9735these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
9736path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
9737to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
9738
9739@example
9740prog.o: No such file or directory.
9741@end example
9742
9743When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
9744the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
9745command again.
9746
9747@node VxWorks Download
9748@subsubsection VxWorks download
9749
9750@cindex download to VxWorks
9751If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
9752object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
9753@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
9754incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
9755command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
9756to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
9757table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
9758the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
9759filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
9760Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
9761to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
9762the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
9763@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
9764and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
9765program, type this on VxWorks:
9766
9767@example
9768-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
9769@end example
d4f3574e
SS
9770
9771@noindent
104c1213
JM
9772Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
9773
9774@example
9775(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
9776(vxgdb) load prog.o
9777@end example
9778
9779@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
9780
9781@smallexample
9782Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
9783@end smallexample
9784
9785You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
9786after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
9787this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
9788auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
9789history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 9790debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
9791table.)
9792
9793@node VxWorks Attach
9794@subsubsection Running tasks
9795
9796@cindex running VxWorks tasks
9797You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
9798follows:
9799
9800@example
9801(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
9802@end example
9803
9804@noindent
9805where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
9806or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
9807the time of attachment.
9808
9809@node Embedded Processors
9810@section Embedded Processors
9811
9812This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
9813configurations.
9814
9815@menu
9816* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
9817* ARM:: ARM
9818* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
9819* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
9820* i960:: Intel i960
9821* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
9822* M68K:: Motorola M68K
9823* M88K:: Motorola M88K
9824* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
9825* PA:: HP PA Embedded
9826* PowerPC: PowerPC
9827* SH:: Hitachi SH
9828* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
9829* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
9830* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
9831* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
9832@end menu
9833
9834@node A29K Embedded
9835@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
9836
9837@menu
9838* A29K UDI::
9839* A29K EB29K::
9840* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
9841* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
9842* Remote Log:: Remote log
9843@end menu
9844
9845@table @code
9846
9847@kindex target adapt
9848@item target adapt @var{dev}
9849Adapt monitor for A29K.
9850
9851@kindex target amd-eb
9852@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
9853@cindex AMD EB29K
9854Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
9855@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
9856@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
9857name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
9858@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
9859
9860@end table
9861
9862@node A29K UDI
9863@subsubsection A29K UDI
9864
9865@cindex UDI
9866@cindex AMD29K via UDI
9867
9868@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
9869protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
9870configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
9871program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
9872use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
9873@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
9874
9875@table @code
9876@item target udi @var{keyword}
9877@kindex udi
9878Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
9879@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
9880This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
9881connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
9882working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
9883to its pathname.
9884@end table
9885
9886@node A29K EB29K
9887@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
9888
9889@cindex EB29K board
9890@cindex running 29K programs
9891
9892AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
9893with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
9894term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
9895@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
9896must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
9897board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
9898assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
9899@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
9900
9901@node Comms (EB29K)
9902@subsubsection Communications setup
9903
9904The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
9905in DOS on the PC:
9906
9907@example
9908C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
9909@end example
9910
9911@noindent
9912This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
9913bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
9914you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
9915end of the connection as well.
9916@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
9917@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9918@c
9919@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
9920@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
9921@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
9922@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
9923@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
9924
9925To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
9926the following at the DOS console:
9927
9928@example
9929C:\> CTTY com1
9930@end example
9931
9932@noindent
9933(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
9934the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
9935had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line).
9936
9937From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
9938@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
9939
9940@example
9941cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
9942@end example
9943
9944@noindent
9945The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
9946serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
9947may look something like the following:
9948
9949@example
9950tip -9600 /dev/ttya
9951@end example
9952
9953@noindent
9954Your system may require a different name where we show
9955@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
9956parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
9957@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
9958system table @file{/etc/remote}.
9959@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
9960@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
9961@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
9962@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
9963@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
9964@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
9965@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
9966@c
9967@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
9968@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
9969@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
9970
9971@kindex EBMON
9972Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
9973directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
9974start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
9975with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
9976@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
9977@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
9978
9979@example
9980C:\> G:
9981
9982G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
9983
9984G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
9985Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
9986Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
9987Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
9988
9989Enter '?' or 'H' for help
9990
9991PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
9992I/O Base = 0x208
9993Memory Base = 0xd0000
9994
9995Data Memory Size = 2048KB
9996Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
9997Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
9998
9999PageSize = 0x400
10000Register Stack Size = 0x800
10001Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10002
10003CPU PRL = 0x3
10004Am29027 Available = No
10005Byte Write Available = Yes
10006
10007# ~.
10008@end example
10009
10010Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10011typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10012running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10013
10014For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10015way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 10016system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
10017PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10018something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10019other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10020from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10021serial line.
10022
10023@node gdb-EB29K
10024@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10025
10026Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10027program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10028name of your 29K program:
10029
10030@example
10031cd /usr/joe/work29k
10032@value{GDBP} myfoo
10033@end example
10034
10035@need 500
10036Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10037
10038@example
10039target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10040@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10041@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10042@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10043@end example
10044
10045@noindent
10046In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10047@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10048@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10049In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10050a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10051the name on the Unix side.
10052
10053At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10054to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10055@code{run}.
10056
10057To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10058command.
10059
10060To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10061once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10062@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10063@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 10064Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
10065and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10066
10067@node Remote Log
10068@subsubsection Remote log
10069@kindex eb.log
10070@cindex log file for EB29K
10071
10072The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10073current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10074@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10075of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10076another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10077unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10078
10079@node ARM
10080@subsection ARM
10081
10082@table @code
10083
10084@kindex target rdi
10085@item target rdi @var{dev}
10086ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10087use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10088monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10089
10090@kindex target rdp
10091@item target rdp @var{dev}
10092ARM Demon monitor.
10093
10094@end table
10095
10096@node H8/300
10097@subsection Hitachi H8/300
10098
10099@table @code
10100
d4f3574e 10101@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10102@item target hms @var{dev}
10103A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10104Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10105line and the communications speed used.
10106
d4f3574e 10107@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10108@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10109E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10110
d4f3574e
SS
10111@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10112@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
10113@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10114@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10115Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10116
10117@end table
10118
10119@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10120@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10121@cindex download to Hitachi SH
10122@cindex Hitachi SH download
10123When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10124board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10125board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10126@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10127
10128@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10129Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10130
10131@enumerate
10132@item
10133that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10134for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10135emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 10136the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
10137H8/300, or H8/500.)
10138
10139@item
10140what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10141serial device available on your host is the default).
10142
10143@item
10144what speed to use over the serial device.
10145@end enumerate
10146
10147@menu
10148* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10149* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10150* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10151@end menu
10152
10153@node Hitachi Boards
10154@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10155
10156@c only for Unix hosts
10157@kindex device
10158@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10159Use the special @code{@value{GDBP}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10160need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10161first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10162hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10163
10164@kindex speed
10165@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10166@code{@value{GDBP}} has another special command to set the communications
10167speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 10168hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
10169the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10170@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
10171
10172The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10173use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10174use a DOS host,
10175@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10176called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10177through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10178to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10179
10180The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10181program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10182sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10183the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10184
10185First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10186board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10187port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10188When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 10189debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
10190for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10191@code{COM2}.
10192
10193@example
10194C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10195C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10196
10197Resident portion of MODE loaded
10198
10199COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10200
10201@end example
10202
10203@quotation
10204@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10205@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10206disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10207your development board.
10208@end quotation
10209
d4f3574e 10210@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
10211Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10212connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10213the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBP}} prompts
10214you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10215commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10216cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10217download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10218the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10219(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10220executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10221@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10222itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10223
10224@smallexample
10225(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 10226@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
104c1213
JM
10227 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10228 the conditions.
2df3850c 10229There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 10230for details.
2df3850c
JM
10231@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10232(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 10233Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 10234(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
10235.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10236.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10237.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10238@end smallexample
10239
10240At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10241you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10242sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10243@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10244resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10245@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10246
10247Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10248available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10249you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10250
10251Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10252@itemize @bullet
10253@item
10254to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10255no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10256
10257@item
10258to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10259normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10260to detect program completion.
10261@end itemize
10262
10263In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10264development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10265
10266@node Hitachi ICE
10267@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10268
d4f3574e 10269@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
10270You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10271Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10272e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10273
10274@table @code
10275@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10276Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10277@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10278@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10279(for example, @samp{9600}).
10280
10281@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10282If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10283specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10284@end table
10285
10286@node Hitachi Special
10287@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10288
10289Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10290
10291@table @code
10292
10293@kindex set machine
10294@kindex show machine
10295@item set machine h8300
10296@itemx set machine h8300h
10297Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10298architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10299to check which variant is currently in effect.
10300
10301@end table
10302
10303@node H8/500
10304@subsection H8/500
10305
10306@table @code
10307
10308@kindex set memory @var{mod}
10309@cindex memory models, H8/500
10310@item set memory @var{mod}
10311@itemx show memory
10312Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10313@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10314memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10315@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10316
10317@end table
10318
10319@node i960
10320@subsection Intel i960
10321
10322@table @code
10323
10324@kindex target mon960
10325@item target mon960 @var{dev}
10326MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10327
10328@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10329An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10330the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10331@file{/dev/ttya}.
10332
10333@end table
10334
10335@cindex Nindy
10336@cindex i960
10337@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10338@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10339tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10340
10341@itemize @bullet
10342@item
10343Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10344Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10345
10346@item
10347By responding to a prompt on startup;
10348
10349@item
10350By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10351session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10352
10353@kindex target nindy
10354@item target nindy @var{devicename}
10355An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10356the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10357@file{/dev/ttya}.
10358
10359@end itemize
10360
10361@cindex download to Nindy-960
10362With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10363downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10364@value{GDBN}.
10365
10366@menu
10367* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10368* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10369* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10370@end menu
10371
10372@node Nindy Startup
10373@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10374
10375If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10376options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10377reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10378
10379@example
10380Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10381@end example
10382
10383@noindent
10384Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10385identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10386simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10387with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10388use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10389
10390@node Nindy Options
10391@subsubsection Options for Nindy
10392
10393These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10394Nindy-960 board attached:
10395
10396@table @code
10397@item -r @var{port}
10398Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10399to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10400configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10401@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10402device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10403suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10404
10405@item -O
10406(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10407the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10408This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10409target architecture.
10410
10411@quotation
10412@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10413connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10414fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10415attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10416this process with an interrupt.
10417@end quotation
10418
10419@item -brk
10420Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10421system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10422
10423@quotation
10424@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10425requires; it only works with a few boards.
10426@end quotation
10427@end table
10428
10429The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10430port.
10431
10432@c @group
10433@node Nindy Reset
10434@subsubsection Nindy reset command
10435
10436@table @code
10437@item reset
10438@kindex reset
10439For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10440system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10441circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10442a break is detected.
10443@end table
10444@c @end group
10445
10446@node M32R/D
10447@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10448
10449@table @code
10450
10451@kindex target m32r
10452@item target m32r @var{dev}
10453Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10454
10455@end table
10456
10457@node M68K
10458@subsection M68k
10459
10460The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10461target command for the following ROM monitors.
10462
10463@table @code
10464
10465@kindex target abug
10466@item target abug @var{dev}
10467ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10468
10469@kindex target cpu32bug
10470@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10471CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10472
10473@kindex target dbug
10474@item target dbug @var{dev}
10475dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10476
10477@kindex target est
10478@item target est @var{dev}
10479EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10480
10481@kindex target rom68k
10482@item target rom68k @var{dev}
10483ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10484
10485@end table
10486
10487If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10488instead have only a single special target command:
10489
10490@table @code
10491
10492@kindex target es1800
10493@item target es1800 @var{dev}
10494ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10495
10496@end table
10497
10498[context?]
10499
10500@table @code
10501
10502@kindex target rombug
10503@item target rombug @var{dev}
10504ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10505
10506@end table
10507
10508@node M88K
10509@subsection M88K
10510
10511@table @code
10512
10513@kindex target bug
10514@item target bug @var{dev}
10515BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10516
10517@end table
10518
10519@node MIPS Embedded
10520@subsection MIPS Embedded
10521
10522@cindex MIPS boards
10523@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10524MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10525you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10526
10527@need 1000
10528Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10529
10530@table @code
10531@item target mips @var{port}
10532@kindex target mips @var{port}
10533To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10534name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10535command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10536the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10537been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10538download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10539
10540For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10541port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10542debugger:
10543
10544@example
10545host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
10546@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10547(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10548(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10549(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
10550@end example
10551
10552@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10553On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10554connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10555concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10556@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10557
10558@item target pmon @var{port}
10559@kindex target pmon @var{port}
10560PMON ROM monitor.
10561
10562@item target ddb @var{port}
10563@kindex target ddb @var{port}
10564NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10565
10566@item target lsi @var{port}
10567@kindex target lsi @var{port}
10568LSI variant of PMON.
10569
10570@kindex target r3900
10571@item target r3900 @var{dev}
10572Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
10573
10574@kindex target array
10575@item target array @var{dev}
10576Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
10577
10578@end table
10579
10580
10581@noindent
10582@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
10583
10584@table @code
10585@item set processor @var{args}
10586@itemx show processor
10587@kindex set processor @var{args}
10588@kindex show processor
10589Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
10590processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
10591For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
10592to use the CPO registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
10593Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
10594is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
10595@value{GDBN} is using.
10596
10597@item set mipsfpu double
10598@itemx set mipsfpu single
10599@itemx set mipsfpu none
10600@itemx show mipsfpu
10601@kindex set mipsfpu
10602@kindex show mipsfpu
10603@cindex MIPS remote floating point
10604@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
10605If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
10606coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
10607need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBINIT}
10608file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
10609functions which return floating point values. It also allows
10610@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
10611functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
10612with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
10613processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
10614double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
10615@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
10616
10617In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
10618floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
10619and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
10620
10621As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
10622@samp{show mipsfpu}.
10623
10624@item set remotedebug @var{n}
10625@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
10626@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
10627@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
10628@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
10629@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
10630@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
10631@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
10632You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
10633by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
10634@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
10635to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
10636at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
10637
10638@item set timeout @var{seconds}
10639@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
10640@itemx show timeout
10641@itemx show retransmit-timeout
10642@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
10643@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
10644@kindex set timeout
10645@kindex show timeout
10646@kindex set retransmit-timeout
10647@kindex show retransmit-timeout
10648You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
10649remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
10650default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
10651waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
10652retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
10653You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
10654retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
10655@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
10656
10657The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
10658is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
10659forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
10660to run before stopping.
10661@end table
10662
10663@node PowerPC
10664@subsection PowerPC
10665
10666@table @code
10667
10668@kindex target dink32
10669@item target dink32 @var{dev}
10670DINK32 ROM monitor.
10671
10672@kindex target ppcbug
10673@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
10674@kindex target ppcbug1
10675@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
10676PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
10677
10678@kindex target sds
10679@item target sds @var{dev}
10680SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
10681
10682@end table
10683
10684@node PA
10685@subsection HP PA Embedded
10686
10687@table @code
10688
10689@kindex target op50n
10690@item target op50n @var{dev}
10691OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
10692
10693@kindex target w89k
10694@item target w89k @var{dev}
10695W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
10696
10697@end table
10698
10699@node SH
10700@subsection Hitachi SH
10701
10702@table @code
10703
d4f3574e 10704@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10705@item target hms @var{dev}
10706A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
10707commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
10708the communications speed used.
10709
d4f3574e 10710@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
10711@item target e7000 @var{dev}
10712E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
10713
d4f3574e
SS
10714@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
10715@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
10716@item target sh3 @var{dev}
10717@item target sh3e @var{dev}
10718Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10719
10720@end table
10721
10722@node Sparclet
10723@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
10724
10725@cindex Sparclet
10726
10727@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
10728Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
10729@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10730both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
d4f3574e 10731@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
10732
10733@table @code
10734@item timeout @var{args}
10735@kindex remotetimeout
d4f3574e 10736@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
104c1213
JM
10737This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10738seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
10739@end table
10740
10741@kindex Compiling
d4f3574e
SS
10742When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
10743information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
10744load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
10745@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
10746
10747@example
10748sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
10749@end example
10750
d4f3574e 10751You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
10752
10753@example
10754sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
10755@end example
10756
10757@kindex Running
10758Once you have set
10759your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
d4f3574e 10760run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
10761(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
10762
10763@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10764
10765@example
10766(gdbslet)
10767@end example
10768
10769@menu
10770* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
10771* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
10772* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
10773* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
10774@end menu
10775
10776@node Sparclet File
10777@subsubsection Setting file to debug
10778
10779The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
10780
10781@example
10782(gdbslet) file prog
10783@end example
10784
10785@need 1000
10786@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
10787@value{GDBN} locates
10788the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
10789path.
10790If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
10791files will be searched as well.
10792@value{GDBN} locates
10793the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
10794path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
10795If it fails
10796to find a file, it displays a message such as:
10797
10798@example
10799prog: No such file or directory.
10800@end example
10801
10802When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
10803the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
10804@code{target} command again.
10805
10806@node Sparclet Connection
10807@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
10808
10809The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
10810To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
10811
10812@example
10813(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
10814Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
10815main () at ../prog.c:3
10816@end example
10817
10818@need 750
10819@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10820
d4f3574e 10821@example
104c1213 10822Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 10823@end example
104c1213
JM
10824
10825@node Sparclet Download
10826@subsubsection Sparclet download
10827
10828@cindex download to Sparclet
10829Once connected to the Sparclet target,
10830you can use the @value{GDBN}
10831@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
10832The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
10833command.
10834Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 10835address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
10836offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
10837of each of the file's sections.
10838For instance, if the program
10839@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
10840and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10841
10842@example
10843(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
10844Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
10845@end example
10846
10847If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
10848to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
10849to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
10850
10851@node Sparclet Execution
10852@subsubsection Running and debugging
10853
10854@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
10855You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
10856commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
10857manual for the list of commands.
10858
10859@example
10860(gdbslet) b main
10861Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
10862(gdbslet) run
10863Starting program: prog
10864Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
108653 char *symarg = 0;
10866(gdbslet) step
108674 char *execarg = "hello!";
10868(gdbslet)
10869@end example
10870
10871@node Sparclite
10872@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
10873
10874@table @code
10875
10876@kindex target sparclite
10877@item target sparclite @var{dev}
10878Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
10879You must use an additional command to debug the program.
10880For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
10881remote protocol.
10882
10883@end table
10884
10885@node ST2000
10886@subsection Tandem ST2000
10887
2df3850c 10888@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
10889STDBUG protocol.
10890
10891To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
10892manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
10893
10894@example
10895target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
10896@end example
10897
10898@noindent
10899to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
10900the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
10901ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
10902connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
10903concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10904
10905The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
10906this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
10907would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
10908(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
10909available on your host computer.
10910@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
10911@c basically hearsay.
10912
10913@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
10914These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
10915environment:
10916
10917@table @code
10918@item st2000 @var{command}
10919@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
10920@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
10921@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
10922Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
10923manual for available commands.
10924
10925@item connect
10926@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
10927Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
10928you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
10929sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
10930@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
10931@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
10932@end table
10933
10934@node Z8000
10935@subsection Zilog Z8000
10936
10937@cindex Z8000
10938@cindex simulator, Z8000
10939@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
10940
10941When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
10942a Z8000 simulator.
10943
10944For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
10945unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
10946segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
10947appropriate by inspecting the object code.
10948
10949@table @code
10950@item target sim @var{args}
10951@kindex sim
d4f3574e 10952@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
10953Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
10954options, specify them via @var{args}.
10955@end table
10956
10957@noindent
10958After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
10959CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
10960@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
10961to run your program, and so on.
10962
d4f3574e
SS
10963As well as making available all the usual machine registers
10964(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
10965additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
10966
10967@table @code
10968
10969@item cycles
10970Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
10971
10972@item insts
10973Counts instructions run in the simulator.
10974
10975@item time
10976Execution time in 60ths of a second.
10977
10978@end table
10979
10980You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
10981conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
10982conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
10983simulated clock ticks.
10984
10985@node Architectures
10986@section Architectures
10987
10988This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 10989all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
10990
10991@menu
10992* A29K::
10993* Alpha::
10994* MIPS::
10995@end menu
10996
10997@node A29K
10998@subsection A29K
10999
11000@table @code
11001
11002@kindex set rstack_high_address
11003@cindex AMD 29K register stack
11004@cindex register stack, AMD29K
11005@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11006On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 11007@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
11008extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11009stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11010memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11011this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11012the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11013address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11014hexadecimal.
11015
11016@kindex show rstack_high_address
11017@item show rstack_high_address
11018Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11019processors.
11020
11021@end table
11022
11023@node Alpha
11024@subsection Alpha
11025
11026See the following section.
11027
11028@node MIPS
11029@subsection MIPS
11030
11031@cindex stack on Alpha
11032@cindex stack on MIPS
11033@cindex Alpha stack
11034@cindex MIPS stack
11035Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11036sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11037find the beginning of a function.
11038
11039@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11040To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11041@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11042you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11043commands:
11044
11045@table @code
11046@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha,MIPS)
11047@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11048Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11049search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11050default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11051larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11052and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11053
11054@item show heuristic-fence-post
11055Display the current limit.
11056@end table
11057
11058@noindent
11059These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11060for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11061
11062
c906108c
SS
11063@node Controlling GDB
11064@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11065
53a5351d
JM
11066You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11067@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 11068data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 11069described here.
c906108c
SS
11070
11071@menu
11072* Prompt:: Prompt
11073* Editing:: Command editing
11074* History:: Command history
11075* Screen Size:: Screen size
11076* Numbers:: Numbers
11077* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11078@end menu
11079
53a5351d 11080@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
11081@section Prompt
11082
11083@cindex prompt
11084
11085@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11086called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11087can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11088instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11089the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11090which one you are talking to.
11091
d4f3574e 11092@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
11093prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11094or a prompt that does not.
11095
11096@table @code
11097@kindex set prompt
11098@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11099Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11100
11101@kindex show prompt
11102@item show prompt
11103Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11104@end table
11105
53a5351d 11106@node Editing
c906108c
SS
11107@section Command editing
11108@cindex readline
11109@cindex command line editing
11110
11111@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11112@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11113command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11114or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11115substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11116debugging sessions.
11117
11118You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11119command @code{set}.
11120
11121@table @code
11122@kindex set editing
11123@cindex editing
11124@item set editing
11125@itemx set editing on
11126Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11127
11128@item set editing off
11129Disable command line editing.
11130
11131@kindex show editing
11132@item show editing
11133Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11134@end table
11135
53a5351d 11136@node History
c906108c
SS
11137@section Command history
11138
11139@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11140debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11141happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11142history facility.
11143
11144@table @code
11145@cindex history substitution
11146@cindex history file
11147@kindex set history filename
11148@kindex GDBHISTFILE
11149@item set history filename @var{fname}
11150Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11151This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11152list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11153exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11154the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11155to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
11156@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11157is not set.
c906108c
SS
11158
11159@cindex history save
11160@kindex set history save
11161@item set history save
11162@itemx set history save on
11163Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11164@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11165
11166@item set history save off
11167Stop recording command history in a file.
11168
11169@cindex history size
11170@kindex set history size
11171@item set history size @var{size}
11172Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11173This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11174@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11175@end table
11176
11177@cindex history expansion
11178History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11179@ifset have-readline-appendices
11180@xref{Event Designators}.
11181@end ifset
11182
11183Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11184is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11185@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11186follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11187a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11188history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11189@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11190
11191The commands to control history expansion are:
11192
11193@table @code
11194@kindex set history expansion
11195@item set history expansion on
11196@itemx set history expansion
11197Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11198
11199@item set history expansion off
11200Disable history expansion.
11201
11202The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11203editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11204or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11205@ifset have-readline-appendices
11206@xref{Command Line Editing}.
11207@end ifset
11208
11209@c @group
11210@kindex show history
11211@item show history
11212@itemx show history filename
11213@itemx show history save
11214@itemx show history size
11215@itemx show history expansion
11216These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11217@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11218@c @end group
11219@end table
11220
11221@table @code
11222@kindex show commands
11223@item show commands
11224Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11225
11226@item show commands @var{n}
11227Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11228
11229@item show commands +
11230Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11231@end table
11232
53a5351d 11233@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
11234@section Screen size
11235@cindex size of screen
11236@cindex pauses in output
11237
11238Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11239information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11240@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11241output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11242to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11243determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11244printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11245rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11246
d4f3574e
SS
11247Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11248driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 11249together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 11250@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
11251you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11252width} commands:
11253
11254@table @code
11255@kindex set height
11256@kindex set width
11257@kindex show width
11258@kindex show height
11259@item set height @var{lpp}
11260@itemx show height
11261@itemx set width @var{cpl}
11262@itemx show width
11263These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11264a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11265commands display the current settings.
11266
11267If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11268output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11269file or to an editor buffer.
11270
11271Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11272from wrapping its output.
11273@end table
11274
53a5351d 11275@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
11276@section Numbers
11277@cindex number representation
11278@cindex entering numbers
11279
2df3850c
JM
11280You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11281@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11282@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11283begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11284default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11285numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11286change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11287radix} command.
c906108c
SS
11288
11289@table @code
11290@kindex set input-radix
11291@item set input-radix @var{base}
11292Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11293for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11294specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11295example, any of
11296
11297@smallexample
11298set radix 012
11299set radix 10.
11300set radix 0xa
11301@end smallexample
11302
11303@noindent
11304sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11305leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11306
11307@kindex set output-radix
11308@item set output-radix @var{base}
11309Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11310for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11311specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11312
11313@kindex show input-radix
11314@item show input-radix
11315Display the current default base for numeric input.
11316
11317@kindex show output-radix
11318@item show output-radix
11319Display the current default base for numeric display.
11320@end table
11321
53a5351d 11322@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
11323@section Optional warnings and messages
11324
2df3850c
JM
11325By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11326running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11327command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11328internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
11329
11330Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11331which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11332see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11333
11334@table @code
11335@kindex set verbose
11336@item set verbose on
11337Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11338
11339@item set verbose off
11340Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11341
11342@kindex show verbose
11343@item show verbose
11344Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11345@end table
11346
2df3850c
JM
11347By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11348object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11349find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11350symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
11351
11352@table @code
2df3850c 11353
c906108c
SS
11354@kindex set complaints
11355@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
11356Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11357unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11358@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11359to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
11360
11361@kindex show complaints
11362@item show complaints
11363Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 11364
c906108c
SS
11365@end table
11366
11367By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11368lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11369you try to run a program which is already running:
11370
11371@example
11372(@value{GDBP}) run
11373The program being debugged has been started already.
11374Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11375@end example
11376
11377If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11378commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11379
11380@table @code
2df3850c 11381
c906108c
SS
11382@kindex set confirm
11383@cindex flinching
11384@cindex confirmation
11385@cindex stupid questions
11386@item set confirm off
11387Disables confirmation requests.
11388
11389@item set confirm on
11390Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11391
11392@kindex show confirm
11393@item show confirm
11394Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 11395
c906108c
SS
11396@end table
11397
53a5351d 11398@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
11399@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11400
11401Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
11402command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11403commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11404files.
c906108c
SS
11405
11406@menu
11407* Define:: User-defined commands
11408* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11409* Command Files:: Command files
11410* Output:: Commands for controlled output
11411@end menu
11412
53a5351d 11413@node Define
c906108c
SS
11414@section User-defined commands
11415
11416@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
11417A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11418which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11419@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11420separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11421via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
11422
11423@smallexample
11424define adder
11425 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11426@end smallexample
11427
d4f3574e
SS
11428@noindent
11429To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
11430
11431@smallexample
11432adder 1 2 3
11433@end smallexample
11434
d4f3574e
SS
11435@noindent
11436This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
c906108c
SS
11437its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11438reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11439functions calls.
11440
11441@table @code
2df3850c 11442
c906108c
SS
11443@kindex define
11444@item define @var{commandname}
11445Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11446by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11447
11448The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11449which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11450commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11451
11452@kindex if
11453@kindex else
11454@item if
11455Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11456It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11457only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11458There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11459by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11460was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11461
11462@kindex while
11463@item while
11464The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11465which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11466execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11467The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11468evaluates to true.
11469
11470@kindex document
11471@item document @var{commandname}
11472Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11473accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11474defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11475reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11476After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11477@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11478
11479You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11480documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11481does not change the documentation.
11482
11483@kindex help user-defined
11484@item help user-defined
11485List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11486(if any) for each.
11487
11488@kindex show user
11489@item show user
11490@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
11491Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11492not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 11493definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 11494
c906108c
SS
11495@end table
11496
11497When user-defined commands are executed, the
11498commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
11499stops execution of the user-defined command.
11500
11501If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
11502without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
11503commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
11504messages when used in a user-defined command.
11505
53a5351d 11506@node Hooks
c906108c 11507@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
11508@cindex command hooks
11509@cindex hooks, for commands
c906108c
SS
11510
11511You may define @emph{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
11512command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
11513command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
11514before that command.
11515
d4f3574e 11516@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
11517In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
11518(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
11519execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
11520displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
11521
c906108c
SS
11522For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
11523single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
11524you could define:
11525
11526@example
11527define hook-stop
11528handle SIGALRM nopass
11529end
11530
11531define hook-run
11532handle SIGALRM pass
11533end
11534
11535define hook-continue
11536handle SIGLARM pass
11537end
11538@end example
c906108c
SS
11539
11540You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
11541not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
11542name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
11543@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
11544@c or not?
11545If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
11546@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
11547(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
11548
11549If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
11550get a warning from the @code{define} command.
11551
53a5351d 11552@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
11553@section Command files
11554
11555@cindex command files
11556A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
11557commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
11558An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
11559the last command, as it would from the terminal.
11560
11561@cindex init file
11562@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 11563@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c
SS
11564When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
11565@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix, or
11566@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. @value{GDBN} reads the init file (if
d4f3574e 11567any) in your home directory@footnote{On DOS/Windows systems, the home
2df3850c
JM
11568directory is the one pointed to by the @code{HOME} environment
11569variable.}, then processes command line options and operands, and then
11570reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory. This is
11571so the init file in your home directory can set options (such as
11572@code{set complaints}) which affect the processing of the command line
11573options and operands. The init files are not executed if you use the
11574@samp{-nx} option; @pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}.
c906108c 11575
c906108c
SS
11576@cindex init file name
11577On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
11578different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
11579form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
11580different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
11581environments with special init file names:
11582
11583@kindex .vxgdbinit
11584@itemize @bullet
11585@item
11586VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @samp{.vxgdbinit}
11587
11588@kindex .os68gdbinit
11589@item
11590OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @samp{.os68gdbinit}
11591
11592@kindex .esgdbinit
11593@item
11594ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @samp{.esgdbinit}
11595@end itemize
c906108c
SS
11596
11597You can also request the execution of a command file with the
11598@code{source} command:
11599
11600@table @code
11601@kindex source
11602@item source @var{filename}
11603Execute the command file @var{filename}.
11604@end table
11605
11606The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
11607printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
11608of the command file.
11609
11610Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
11611without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
11612normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
11613when called from command files.
11614
53a5351d 11615@node Output
c906108c
SS
11616@section Commands for controlled output
11617
11618During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
11619@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
11620explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
11621describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
11622want.
11623
11624@table @code
11625@kindex echo
11626@item echo @var{text}
11627@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
11628@c because it is not in ANSI.
11629Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
11630@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
11631newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
11632In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
11633by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
11634string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
11635trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
11636To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
11637@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
11638
11639A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
11640the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
11641
11642@example
11643echo This is some text\n\
11644which is continued\n\
11645onto several lines.\n
11646@end example
11647
11648produces the same output as
11649
11650@example
11651echo This is some text\n
11652echo which is continued\n
11653echo onto several lines.\n
11654@end example
11655
11656@kindex output
11657@item output @var{expression}
11658Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
11659newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
11660value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
11661on expressions.
11662
11663@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
11664Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
11665the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
11666formats}, for more information.
11667
11668@kindex printf
11669@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
11670Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
11671@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
11672either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
11673@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
11674subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
11675@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
11676@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
11677@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
11678@c supported.
c906108c
SS
11679
11680@example
11681printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
11682@end example
11683
11684For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
11685
11686@smallexample
11687printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
11688@end smallexample
11689
11690The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
11691string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
11692letter.
11693@end table
11694
53a5351d 11695@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
11696@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
11697
11698@cindex Emacs
11699@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
11700A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
11701edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
11702@value{GDBN}.
11703
11704To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
11705executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
11706@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
11707created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 11708@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
11709
11710Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
11711things:
11712
11713@itemize @bullet
11714@item
11715All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
11716@end itemize
11717
11718This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
11719and output done by the program you are debugging.
11720
11721This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
11722commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
11723in this way.
11724
11725All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
11726with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
11727way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
11728stop.
11729
11730@itemize @bullet
11731@item
11732@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
11733@end itemize
11734
11735Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
11736source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
11737left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
11738source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
11739and the source.
11740
11741Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
11742usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
11743
11744@quotation
11745@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
11746current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
11747the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
11748appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
11749environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
11750session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
11751back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
11752avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
11753your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
11754@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
11755
11756A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
11757switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
11758@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
11759@end quotation
11760
11761By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
11762you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
11763several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
11764Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
11765
11766@example
11767(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
11768@end example
11769
11770@noindent
d4f3574e 11771(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
11772in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
11773``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
11774
11775In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
11776addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
11777
11778@table @kbd
11779@item C-h m
11780Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
11781
11782@item M-s
11783Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
11784update the display window to show the current file and location.
11785
11786@item M-n
11787Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
11788calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
11789to show the current file and location.
11790
11791@item M-i
11792Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
11793display window accordingly.
11794
11795@item M-x gdb-nexti
11796Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
11797display window accordingly.
11798
11799@item C-c C-f
11800Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
11801@code{finish} command.
11802
11803@item M-c
11804Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
11805command.
11806
11807@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
11808
11809@item M-u
11810Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
11811(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
11812like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
11813
11814@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
11815
11816@item M-d
11817Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
11818@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
11819
11820@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
11821
11822@item C-x &
11823Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
11824of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
11825around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
11826then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
11827argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
11828
11829You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
11830@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
11831otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
11832inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
11833wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
11834list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
11835formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
11836is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
11837@end table
11838
11839In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
11840tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
11841
11842If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
11843it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
11844request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
11845the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
11846frame.
11847
11848The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
11849which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
11850the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
11851communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
11852delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
11853to correspond properly with the code.
11854
11855@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
11856@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
11857@ignore
11858@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
11859@kindex Epoch
11860@kindex inspect
11861
11862Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
11863called the @code{epoch}
11864environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
11865@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
11866each value is printed in its own window.
11867@end ignore
c906108c
SS
11868
11869@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
11870@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
11871@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
11872@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
11873
11874Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
11875
11876Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
11877may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
11878the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
11879reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
11880
11881In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
11882information that enables us to fix the bug.
11883
11884@menu
11885* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
11886* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
11887@end menu
11888
53a5351d 11889@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
11890@section Have you found a bug?
11891@cindex bug criteria
11892
11893If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
11894
11895@itemize @bullet
11896@cindex fatal signal
11897@cindex debugger crash
11898@cindex crash of debugger
11899@item
11900If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
11901@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
11902
11903@cindex error on valid input
11904@item
11905If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
11906bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
11907somewhere in the connection to the target.)
11908
11909@cindex invalid input
11910@item
11911If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
11912that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
11913``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
11914for traditional practice''.
11915
11916@item
11917If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
11918for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
11919@end itemize
11920
53a5351d 11921@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
11922@section How to report bugs
11923@cindex bug reports
11924@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
11925
c906108c
SS
11926A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
11927If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
11928contact that organization first.
11929
11930You can find contact information for many support companies and
11931individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
11932distribution.
11933@c should add a web page ref...
11934
11935In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
11936@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
11937
11938@example
d4f3574e 11939bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
11940@end example
11941
11942@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 11943@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
11944not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
11945@samp{bug-gdb}.
11946
11947The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
11948serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
11949the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
11950newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
11951problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
11952path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
11953we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
11954bug reports to the mailing list.
11955
11956As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
11957
11958@example
11959@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
11960Free Software Foundation Inc.
1196159 Temple Place - Suite 330
11962Boston, MA 02111-1307
11963USA
11964@end example
c906108c
SS
11965
11966The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
11967@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
11968fact or leave it out, state it!
11969
11970Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
11971problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
11972assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
11973Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
11974stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
11975name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
11976of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
11977the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
11978easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
11979
11980Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
11981bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
11982you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
11983self-contained.
11984
11985Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
11986bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
11987@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
11988bugs properly.
11989
11990To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
11991
11992@itemize @bullet
11993@item
11994The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
11995with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
11996version}.
11997
11998Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
11999the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12000
12001@item
12002The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12003version number.
12004
c906108c
SS
12005@item
12006What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12007``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
12008
12009@item
12010What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12011debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12012C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12013information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12014compilers.
12015
12016@item
12017The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12018observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12019you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12020Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12021
12022If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12023and then we might not encounter the bug.
12024
12025@item
12026A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12027reproduce the bug.
12028
12029@item
12030A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12031incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12032
12033Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12034will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12035not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12036a chance to make a mistake.
12037
12038Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12039say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12040copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12041the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12042crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12043ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12044us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12045to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12046
c906108c
SS
12047@item
12048If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12049diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12050it by context, not by line number.
12051
12052The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12053sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 12054
c906108c
SS
12055@end itemize
12056
12057Here are some things that are not necessary:
12058
12059@itemize @bullet
12060@item
12061A description of the envelope of the bug.
12062
12063Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12064which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12065changes will not affect it.
12066
12067This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12068will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12069with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12070We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12071
12072Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12073of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12074output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12075less time, and so on.
12076
12077However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12078report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12079
12080@item
12081A patch for the bug.
12082
12083A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12084the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12085a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12086to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12087
12088Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12089construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12090through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12091to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12092
12093And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12094patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12095help us to understand.
12096
12097@item
12098A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12099
12100Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12101things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12102@end itemize
12103
12104@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12105@c and consists of the two following files:
12106@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12107@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12108@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12109@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12110@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 12111@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
12112
12113
c906108c 12114@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
12115@appendix Formatting Documentation
12116
12117@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12118@cindex reference card
12119The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12120for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12121subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12122@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12123release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12124you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12125
12126The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12127can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12128
12129@example
12130make refcard.dvi
12131@end example
12132
12133The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12134mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12135that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12136high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12137your @sc{dvi} output program.
12138
12139@cindex documentation
12140
12141All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12142distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12143a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12144on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12145formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12146and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12147
12148@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12149version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12150file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12151subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12152necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12153but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12154Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12155@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12156
12157If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12158Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12159@code{makeinfo}.
12160
12161If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12162@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12163version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12164
12165@example
12166cd gdb
12167make gdb.info
12168@end example
12169
12170If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12171a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12172Texinfo definitions file.
12173
12174@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12175produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12176document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12177has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12178command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12179(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12180require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12181
12182@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12183@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12184written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12185typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12186and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12187directory.
12188
12189If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12190typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12191subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12192@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12193
12194@example
12195make gdb.dvi
12196@end example
12197
12198Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 12199
53a5351d 12200@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
12201@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12202@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12203@cindex installation
12204
c906108c
SS
12205@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12206of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12207build the @code{gdb} program.
12208@iftex
12209@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12210@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12211look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12212installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12213@end iftex
12214
12215The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12216@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12217appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12218
12219For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12220@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12221
12222@table @code
12223@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12224script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12225
12226@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12227the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12228
12229@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12230source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12231
12232@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12233@sc{gnu} include files
12234
12235@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12236source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12237
12238@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12239source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12240
12241@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12242source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12243
12244@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12245source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12246
12247@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12248source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12249@end table
12250
12251The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12252from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12253this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12254
12255First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12256if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12257identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12258argument.
12259
12260For example:
12261
12262@example
12263cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12264./configure @var{host}
12265make
12266@end example
12267
12268@noindent
12269where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12270@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12271(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12272correct value by examining your system.)
12273
12274Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12275@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12276libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12277binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12278
12279@need 750
12280@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12281system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12282shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12283
12284@example
12285sh configure @var{host}
12286@end example
12287
12288If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12289directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12290@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12291creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12292you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12293
12294You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12295subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12296configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12297
12298For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12299the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12300
12301@example
12302@group
12303cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12304../configure @var{host}
12305@end group
12306@end example
12307
12308You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12309However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12310the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12311that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12312let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12313
12314@menu
12315* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12316* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12317* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12318@end menu
12319
53a5351d 12320@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
12321@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12322
12323If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12324you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12325host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12326allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12327rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12328handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12329@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12330program specified there.
12331
12332To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12333with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12334(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12335itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12336would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12337the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12338
12339For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12340separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12341
12342@example
12343@group
12344cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12345mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12346cd ../gdb-sun4
12347../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12348make
12349@end group
12350@end example
12351
12352When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12353directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12354(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12355the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12356directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12357@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12358
12359One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12360directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12361@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12362programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12363You specify a cross-debugging target by
12364giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12365
12366When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12367it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12368called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12369
12370The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12371directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12372directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12373directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12374will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12375
12376When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12377directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12378if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12379with each other.
12380
53a5351d 12381@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
12382@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12383
12384The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12385script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12386aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12387of information in the following pattern:
12388
12389@example
12390@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12391@end example
12392
12393For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12394or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12395option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12396
12397The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12398any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12399aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12400@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12401script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12402abbreviations---for example:
12403
12404@smallexample
12405% sh config.sub i386-linux
12406i386-pc-linux-gnu
12407% sh config.sub alpha-linux
12408alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12409% sh config.sub hp9k700
12410hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12411% sh config.sub sun4
12412sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12413% sh config.sub sun3
12414m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12415% sh config.sub i986v
12416Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12417@end smallexample
12418
12419@noindent
12420@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12421directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12422
53a5351d 12423@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
12424@section @code{configure} options
12425
12426Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12427are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12428several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12429Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12430
12431@example
12432configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12433 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12434 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12435 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12436 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12437 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12438 @var{host}
12439@end example
12440
12441@noindent
12442You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12443@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
12444@samp{--}.
12445
12446@table @code
12447@item --help
12448Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
12449
12450@item --prefix=@var{dir}
12451Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
12452@file{@var{dir}}.
12453
12454@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
12455Configure the source to install programs under directory
12456@file{@var{dir}}.
12457
12458@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
12459@need 2000
12460@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
12461@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
12462@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
12463Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
12464@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
12465build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
12466directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
12467the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
12468directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
12469the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
12470@var{dirname}.
12471
12472@item --norecursion
12473Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
12474propagate configuration to subdirectories.
12475
12476@item --target=@var{target}
12477Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
12478@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
12479programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
12480
12481There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
12482
12483@item @var{host} @dots{}
12484Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
12485
12486There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
12487@end table
12488
12489There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
12490needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 12491
53a5351d 12492@node Index
c906108c
SS
12493@unnumbered Index
12494
12495@printindex cp
12496
12497@tex
12498% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
12499% meantime:
12500\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
12501\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
12502\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
12503\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
12504\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
12505\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
12506\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
12507\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
12508\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
12509\page\colophon
12510% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
12511@end tex
12512
12513@contents
12514@bye
This page took 0.639726 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.